blob: c23133d685dce8dfbe75ac2c1a1b758fd4d49624 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
223 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000224 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
225 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000226 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
227 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000228 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000229 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000230 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000231 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000232 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000233 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000234 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000235 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000236 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000237 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000238
239 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000240 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000242 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000243 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000244 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000245 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000246 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
247 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000248 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000249
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000250 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
252 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
253 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000254 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000255 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
256 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000257 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
258 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000259 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000260 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000261 }
262
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000263 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
264 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
265 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000266 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
267 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000268 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000269
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000270 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000271 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000272
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000273 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000274 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000275 return C;
276 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000277
278 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
279 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
280 }
281
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000282
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000283 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
284 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
285 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
286 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
287 // modified.
288 //
289 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000290 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000291 if (&I != V) {
292 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
293 return &I;
294 } else {
295 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
296 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000297 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000298 return &I;
299 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000300 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000301
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000302 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
303 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
304 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
305 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
306 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
307 //
308 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
309 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
310 if (Old != New)
311 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000313 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000315 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000316 return true;
317 }
318
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000319 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
320 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
321 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
322 // this function.
323 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
324 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
325 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000326 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000327 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000328 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
329 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000330
331 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
332 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
333 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
334 }
335
336 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
337 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
338 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
339 }
340 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
341 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
342 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000343
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000344 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000345 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
346 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
347 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
348 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000349 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
350 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000351 Instruction *InsertBefore);
352
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000353 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
354 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000355 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000356
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000357 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
358 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
359 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
360
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000361 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
362 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000363 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
364 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
365 unsigned Depth = 0);
366
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000367 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
368 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
369
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000370 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
371 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
372 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
373 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
374
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000375 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
376 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
377 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
380
381
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000382 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
383 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000385 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000387 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000388 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000389 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000390 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000391 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000395
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000396 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000398 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
399 unsigned CastOpc,
400 int &NumCastsRemoved);
401 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
402 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000403
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000404 };
405}
406
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000407char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
408static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
409X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
410
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000412// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000413static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
414 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
415 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000416 return 3;
417 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000418 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000419 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
420 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000421}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000422
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000423// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
424// it.
425static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000426 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000427}
428
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000429// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
430// though a va_arg area...
431static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000432 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
433 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
434 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000435 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000436 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000437}
438
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000439/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
440/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
441/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000442static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
443 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000444 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000446 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
447 // GetElementPtrInst?
448 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
449 return GEP->getOperand(0);
450 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000453 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000454 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
455 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
456 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
457 I != E; ++I) {
458 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
459 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
460 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
461 return 0;
462 }
463 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
464 return CE->getOperand(0);
465 }
466 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000467 return 0;
468}
469
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000470/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
471/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000472static Instruction::CastOps
473isEliminableCastPair(
474 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
475 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
476 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
477 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
478) {
479
480 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
481 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000482
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000483 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
484 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
485 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000486
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000487 return Instruction::CastOps(
488 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
489 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490}
491
492/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
493/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
494/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000495static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
496 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
498
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000499 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000500 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000501 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000502 return false;
503 return true;
504}
505
506/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
507/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
508/// casts that are known to not do anything...
509///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000510Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
511 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000512 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
513 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
514 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000515 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000516
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000517 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518}
519
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000520// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
521// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000522//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000523// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
524// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
525// binary operators.
526//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000527// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
528// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000529//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000530bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000531 bool Changed = false;
532 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
533 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000534
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000535 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
536 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
538 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
539 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000540 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
541 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
542 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000543 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
544 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
545 return true;
546 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
547 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
548 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
549 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
550 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
551
552 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000553 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000554 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000555 Op1->getOperand(0),
556 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000557 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000558 I.setOperand(0, New);
559 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
560 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000561 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000562 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000563 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000564}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000565
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000566/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
567/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
568/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
569bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
570 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
571 return false;
572 I.swapOperands();
573 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
574 return true;
575}
576
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
578// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000579//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000580static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
581 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000582 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000583
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000584 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
585 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
586 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000587
588 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
589 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
591
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000592 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000593}
594
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000595static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
596 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000597 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000598
599 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000600 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000601 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000602 return 0;
603}
604
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000605// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
606// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000607// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
608// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000609//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000610static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000611 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000612 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000613 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000614 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000615 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000616 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000617 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000618 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000619 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000620 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000621 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000622 return I->getOperand(0);
623 }
624 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000625 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000626}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000627
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000628/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
629/// expression, return it.
630static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
631 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
632 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
633 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
634 return cast<User>(V);
635 return false;
636}
637
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000638/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
639/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000640static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
641 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000642 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000643 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000644 return CE->getOpcode();
645 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
646 return Instruction::UserOp1;
647}
648
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000649/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000650static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000651 APInt Val(C->getValue());
652 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000654/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000655static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000656 APInt Val(C->getValue());
657 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000658}
659/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
660static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
661 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
662}
663/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
664static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
665 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
666}
667/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
668static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
669 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
670}
671/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
672static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
673 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000674}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000675/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
676/// this size.
677static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
678 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
679 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
680 if (sign) {
681 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
682 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
683 } else {
684 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
685 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
686 }
687
688 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
689
690 if (sign) {
691 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
692 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
693 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
694 } else
695 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
696}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000697
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000698
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000699/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
700/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
701/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
702/// constant and return true.
703static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000704 APInt Demanded) {
705 assert(I && "No instruction?");
706 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
707
708 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
709 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
710 if (!OpC) return false;
711
712 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
713 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
714 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
715 return false;
716
717 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
718 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
719 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
720 return true;
721}
722
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000723// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
724// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
725// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
726// min/max.
727static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000728 const APInt& KnownZero,
729 const APInt& KnownOne,
730 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
731 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
732 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
733 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
734 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000736 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000737
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000738 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
739 // bit if it is unknown.
740 Min = KnownOne;
741 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
742
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000743 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000744 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
745 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000746 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747}
748
749// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
750// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
751// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
752// min/max.
753static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000754 const APInt &KnownZero,
755 const APInt &KnownOne,
756 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
757 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000758 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
759 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
760 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
761 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000762 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000763
764 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
765 Min = KnownOne;
766 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
767 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
768}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000769
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000770/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
771/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
772/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
773/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
774/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
775/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
776/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
777/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
778/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
779/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
780/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
781/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
782/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
783/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
784/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
785bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
786 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
787 unsigned Depth) {
788 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
789 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
790 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
791 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
792 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
793 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
794 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
796 must have same BitWidth");
797 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
798 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
799 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
800 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
801 return false;
802 }
803
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000804 KnownZero.clear();
805 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000806 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
807 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
808 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
810 return false;
811 }
812 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
813 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
814 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
815 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
816 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
817 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
818 return false;
819 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
820 return false;
821 }
822
823 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
824 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
825
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000826 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
827 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
828 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000829 default:
830 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
831 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000832 case Instruction::And:
833 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
834 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
835 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
836 return true;
837 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
838 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
839
840 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
841 // LHS.
842 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
843 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
844 return true;
845 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
846 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
847
848 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
849 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
850 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
851 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
852 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
853 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
854 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
855 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
856
857 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
858 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
859 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
860
861 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
862 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
863 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
864
865 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
866 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
867 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
868 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
869 break;
870 case Instruction::Or:
871 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
872 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
873 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
874 return true;
875 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
876 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
877 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
878 // LHS.
879 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
880 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
881 return true;
882 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
883 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
884
885 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
886 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
889 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
890 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
891 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
892 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
893
894 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
895 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
896 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
897 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
898 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
899 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
900 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
901 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
902
903 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
904 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
906
907 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
908 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
909 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
910 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
911 break;
912 case Instruction::Xor: {
913 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
914 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
915 return true;
916 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
917 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
918 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
919 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
920 return true;
921 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
922 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
923
924 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
925 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
926 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
927 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
928 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
930
931 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
932 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
933 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
934 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
935 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
936 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
939 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
940 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
941 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
942 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000943 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000944 I->getName());
945 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
947 }
948
949 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
950 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
951 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
952 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
953 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
954 // all known
955 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
956 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
957 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000958 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000959 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
960 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
961 }
962 }
963
964 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
965 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
970 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
971 break;
972 }
973 case Instruction::Select:
974 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
975 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
976 return true;
977 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
978 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
979 return true;
980 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
981 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
982 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
983 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984
985 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
986 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
987 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
988 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
989 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
990
991 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
992 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 break;
995 case Instruction::Trunc: {
996 uint32_t truncBf =
997 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000998 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
999 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1000 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1001 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1002 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003 return true;
1004 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1008 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1009 break;
1010 }
1011 case Instruction::BitCast:
1012 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1013 return false;
1014
1015 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1016 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1017 return true;
1018 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1019 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1020 break;
1021 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1022 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1023 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001024 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001026 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1027 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1028 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001029 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1030 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001031 return true;
1032 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1033 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001038 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 break;
1040 }
1041 case Instruction::SExt: {
1042 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1043 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001044 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001045
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001046 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001047 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001048
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001049 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001050 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1051 // bit is demanded.
1052 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001053 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001054
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001055 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1056 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1057 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001058 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1059 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001060 return true;
1061 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1062 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1063 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1064 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1065 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1066
1067 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1068 // top bits of the result.
1069
1070 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1071 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001072 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001073 {
1074 // Convert to ZExt cast
1075 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1076 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001079 }
1080 break;
1081 }
1082 case Instruction::Add: {
1083 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1084 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1085 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001086 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001087
1088 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1089 // we can do.
1090 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1091 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1092 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1093 if (RHS->isZero())
1094 break;
1095
1096 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1097 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001098 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001099
1100 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1101 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1102 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1103 return true;
1104
1105 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1106 // the constant.
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Avoid excess work.
1111 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1112 break;
1113
1114 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1115 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1116 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001117 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 I->getName());
1119 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1120 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1121 }
1122
1123 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1124 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1125 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1126 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1127 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1128
1129 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1130 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1131 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001132 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1133 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134
1135 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1136
1137 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1138 // other, and there is no input carry.
1139 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1140 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1141
1142 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1143 // is no input carry.
1144 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1145 } else {
1146 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1147 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1150 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001151 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1156 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1157 return true;
1158 }
1159 }
1160 break;
1161 }
1162 case Instruction::Sub:
1163 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1164 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1167 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001168 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001169 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001170 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1171 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1172 return true;
1173 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1174 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1175 return true;
1176 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001177 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1178 // the known zeros and ones.
1179 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180 break;
1181 case Instruction::Shl:
1182 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001183 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001184 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1187 return true;
1188 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1189 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1190 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1191 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1192 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001194 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::LShr:
1198 // For a logical shift right
1199 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001200 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001201
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001203 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1204 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1206 return true;
1207 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1208 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001209 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1210 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001211 if (ShiftAmt) {
1212 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001213 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001214 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1215 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001216 }
1217 break;
1218 case Instruction::AShr:
1219 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1220 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1221 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1222 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1223 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1224 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001225 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1227 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1228 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1229 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001230
1231 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1232 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1233 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1234 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001235
1236 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001237 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001239 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001240 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001241 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1242 // demanded.
1243 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1244 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001246 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001247 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1248 return true;
1249 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1250 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1251 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001252 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1254 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1255
1256 // Handle the sign bits.
1257 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1258 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1259 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1260
1261 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1262 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001263 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001264 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1265 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001266 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1268 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1269 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1270 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1271 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001275 case Instruction::SRem:
1276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1278 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001279 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1280 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1281
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001282 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001283 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1289 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001290
1291 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001292
1293 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1294 }
1295 }
1296 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001298 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1299 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1301 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001304 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001305 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001306 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1307 return true;
1308
1309 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1310 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1311 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001312 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001314 case Instruction::Call:
1315 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1316 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1317 default: break;
1318 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1319 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1320 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1321 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1322 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1323
1324 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1325 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1326 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1327 NLZ &= ~7;
1328 NTZ &= ~7;
1329 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1330 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1331 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1332 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1333
1334 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1335 // the right place.
1336 Instruction *NewVal;
1337 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1338 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1339 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1340 else
1341 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1342 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1343 NewVal->takeName(I);
1344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1345 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1346 }
1347
1348 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1349 break;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001353 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001354 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001355 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001356
1357 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1358 // constant.
1359 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1360 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1361 return false;
1362}
1363
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001364
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001365/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001366/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1367/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1368/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1369///
1370/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1371/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1372/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1373Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1374 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1375 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001376 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001377 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1378 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001379 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001380
1381 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1382 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1383 UndefElts = EltMask;
1384 return 0;
1385 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1386 UndefElts = EltMask;
1387 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1388 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001389
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001390 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001391 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1392 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001393 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1394
1395 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1397 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1398 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1399 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1400 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1401 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1402 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1403 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1404 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1405 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001406
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001407 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001408 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001409 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1410 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001413
1414 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1415 // anything.
1416 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1417 return 0;
1418
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001419 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001420 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1421 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1422 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1423 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1424 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1425 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001426 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001427 }
1428
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001429 // Limit search depth.
1430 if (Depth == 10)
1431 return false;
1432
1433 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1434 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1435 // are needed.
1436 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1437 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1438 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1439 // the main instcombine process.
1440 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001441 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1442 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001443
1444 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1445 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001446 }
1447
1448 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1449 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1450
1451 bool MadeChange = false;
1452 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1453 Value *TmpV;
1454 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1455 default: break;
1456
1457 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1458 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1459 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001460 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001461 if (Idx == 0) {
1462 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1463 // which elt is getting updated.
1464 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1465 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1466 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1467 break;
1468 }
1469
1470 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1471 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001472 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001473 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1474 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1475
1476 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1477 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1478 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1479 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1480 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1481 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1482
1483 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001484 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1485 break;
1486 }
1487 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1488 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001489 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1490 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001491 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1492 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1493 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1494 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1495 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001496 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001497 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001498 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001499 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1500 else
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001501 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001502 }
1503 }
1504 }
1505
1506 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1507 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1508 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1509
1510 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1511 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1512 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1513 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1514
1515 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1516 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1517 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001518 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001519 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1520 UndefElts |= NewBit;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001521 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001522 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1523 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1524 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1525 } else {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001526 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - LHSVWidth)) & 1) << i;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001527 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1528 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1529 }
1530 }
1531
1532 if (NewUndefElts) {
1533 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1534 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1535 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1536 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1537 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1538 else
1539 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1540 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1541 }
1542 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1543 MadeChange = true;
1544 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001545 break;
1546 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001547 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001548 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001549 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1550 if (!VTy) break;
1551 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1552 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1553 unsigned Ratio;
1554
1555 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001556 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001557 // elements as are demanded of us.
1558 Ratio = 1;
1559 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1560 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1561 // Untested so far.
1562 break;
1563
1564 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1565 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1566 // elements are live.
1567 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1568 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1569 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1570 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1571 }
1572 } else {
1573 // Untested so far.
1574 break;
1575
1576 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1577 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1578 // live.
1579 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1580 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1581 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1582 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1583 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001584
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001585 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1586 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1587 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1588 if (TmpV) {
1589 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1590 MadeChange = true;
1591 }
1592
1593 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1594 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1595 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1596 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1597 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1598 // undef.
1599 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1600 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1601 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1602 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1603 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1604 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1605 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1606 // elements are undef.
1607 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1608 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1609 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1610 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1611 }
1612 break;
1613 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001614 case Instruction::And:
1615 case Instruction::Or:
1616 case Instruction::Xor:
1617 case Instruction::Add:
1618 case Instruction::Sub:
1619 case Instruction::Mul:
1620 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1621 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1622 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1623 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1624 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1625 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1626 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1627
1628 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1629 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1630 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1631 break;
1632
1633 case Instruction::Call: {
1634 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1635 if (!II) break;
1636 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1637 default: break;
1638
1639 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1640 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1642 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1643 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1644 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1645 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1646 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1647 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1648 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1649 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1650 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1651 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1652 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1653 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1654 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1655
1656 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1657 // scalarize it now.
1658 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1659 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1660 default: break;
1661 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1662 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1663 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1664 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1665 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1666 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1667 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1668 // Extract the element as scalars.
1669 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1670 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1671
1672 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1673 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1674 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1675 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001676 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001677 II->getName()), *II);
1678 break;
1679 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1680 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001681 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001682 II->getName()), *II);
1683 break;
1684 }
1685
1686 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001687 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1688 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001689 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1690 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1691 return New;
1692 }
1693 }
1694
1695 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1696 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1697 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1698 break;
1699 }
1700 break;
1701 }
1702 }
1703 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1704}
1705
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001706
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001707/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1708/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1709/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1710/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1711/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1712/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1713/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1714///
1715template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001716static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001717 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1718 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1719
1720 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1721 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1722 return F.apply(Root);
1723
1724 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1725 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001726 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001727 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1728 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1729
1730 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1731 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1732 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1733 ShouldApply = true;
1734 }
1735
1736 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1737 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1738 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001739 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1740 // and perform the reassociation.
1741 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1742
1743 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1744 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1745
1746 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1747 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001748 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001749 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1750 return 0;
1751 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001752 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001753 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001754 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001755 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001756 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001757
1758 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1759 // get to LHSI.
1760 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1761 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001762 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1763 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001764 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001765 ARI = NextLHSI;
1766
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001767 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1768 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1769 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1770 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1771 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001772
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001773 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1774 // the transformation...
1775 return F.apply(Root);
1776 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001777
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001778 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1779 }
1780 return 0;
1781}
1782
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001783namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001784
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001785// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001786struct AddRHS {
1787 Value *RHS;
1788 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1789 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1790 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001791 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1792 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001793 }
1794};
1795
1796// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1797// iff C1&C2 == 0
1798struct AddMaskingAnd {
1799 Constant *C2;
1800 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1801 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001802 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001803 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001804 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001805 }
1806 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001807 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001808 }
1809};
1810
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001811}
1812
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001813static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001814 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001815 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001816 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001817 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001818
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001819 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001820 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001821 }
1822
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001823 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001824 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1825 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001826
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001827 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1828 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001829 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1830 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001831 }
1832
1833 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1834 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1835 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1836 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001837 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001838 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001839 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001840 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001841 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001842 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001843 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001844 abort();
1845 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001846 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1847}
1848
1849// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1850// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1851// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1852// not have a second operand.
1853static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1854 InstCombiner *IC) {
1855 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1856 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1857 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1858 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1859
1860 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001861 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001862 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001863
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001864 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1865 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1866
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001867 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1868 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001869 }
1870 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001871}
1872
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001873
1874/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1875/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1876/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1877Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1878 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001879 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001880 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001881
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001882 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1883 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001884 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001885 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1886 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1887 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1888 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001889 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001890 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1891
1892 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1893 // loop.
1894 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1895 return 0;
1896 }
1897
1898 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1899 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1900 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1901 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1902 if (NonConstBB) {
1903 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1904 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1905 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001906
1907 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001908 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001909 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001910 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001911 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001912
1913 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1914 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1915 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001916 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001917 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001918 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001919 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1920 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1921 else
1922 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001923 } else {
1924 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1925 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001926 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001927 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1928 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001929 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001930 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001931 CI->getPredicate(),
1932 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1933 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001934 else
1935 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1936
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001937 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001938 }
1939 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001940 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001941 } else {
1942 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1943 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001944 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001945 Value *InV;
1946 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001947 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001948 } else {
1949 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001950 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001951 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1952 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001953 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001954 }
1955 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001956 }
1957 }
1958 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1959}
1960
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001961
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001962/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1963/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1964/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1965/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1966bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1967 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1968 // ones.
1969
1970 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1971 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1972 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1973 // sign extend fine.
1974 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1975 return true;
1976
1977
1978 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1979 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1980 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1981 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1982
1983 // TODO: Implement.
1984
1985 return false;
1986}
1987
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001988
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001989Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001990 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001991 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001992
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001993 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001994 // X + undef -> undef
1995 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1997
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001998 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001999 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00002000 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002002 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002003 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
2004 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00002006 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002007
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002008 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002009 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002010 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002011 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002012 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002013 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002014
2015 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2016 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002017 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2018 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2019 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2020 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2021 return &I;
2022 }
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002023
2024 // zext(i1) - 1 -> select i1, 0, -1
2025 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
2026 if (CI->isAllOnesValue() &&
2027 ZI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2028 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0),
2029 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2030 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002031 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002032
2033 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2034 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2035 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002036
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002037 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2038 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002039 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2040 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002041 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002042 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002043
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002044 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002045 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2046 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002047 do {
2048 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002049 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2050 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002051 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2052 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002053 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002054 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2055 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002056 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002057 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002058 }
2059 }
2060 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002061 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2062 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2063 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002064
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002065 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002066 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2067 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2068 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002069 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2070 switch (Size) {
2071 default: break;
2072 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2073 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2074 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2075 }
2076 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002077 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002078 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002079 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002080 }
2081 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002082 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002083
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002084 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2085 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2086
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002087 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002088 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002089 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002090
2091 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2092 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2093 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2095 }
2096 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2097 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2098 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2099 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2100 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002101 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002102
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002103 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002104 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2105 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002106 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2107 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002108 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002109 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002110 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002111 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002112 }
2113
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002114 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002115 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002116
2117 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002118 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2119 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002120 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002121
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002122
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002123 ConstantInt *C2;
2124 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2125 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002126 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002127
2128 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2129 ConstantInt *C1;
2130 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002131 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002132 }
2133
2134 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002135 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002136 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002137
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002138 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002139 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002141
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002142
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002143 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002144 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002145 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2146 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002147
2148 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2149 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2150 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2151 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2152 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2153 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2154 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2155 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2156 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2157 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2158
2159 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002160 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002161 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002162 }
2163 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002164
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002165 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002166 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002167 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2168 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2169 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2170 if (W != Y) {
2171 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002172 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002173 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002174 std::swap(W, X);
2175 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002176 std::swap(Y, Z);
2177 std::swap(W, X);
2178 }
2179 }
2180
2181 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002182 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002183 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002184 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002185 }
2186 }
2187 }
2188
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002189 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002190 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002191 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002192 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002193
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002194 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2195 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002196 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002197 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2198 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2199 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002200 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002201
2202 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002203 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002204
2205 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002206 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002207
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002208 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2209 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002210 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002211 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002212 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002213 }
2214 }
2215 }
2216
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002217 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2218 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002219 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002220 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002221 }
2222
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002223 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002224 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002225 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002226 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2227 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002228 if (!CI) {
2229 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2230 Other = LHS;
2231 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002232 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002233 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2234 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002235 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002236 unsigned AS =
2237 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002238 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2239 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002240 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002241 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002242 }
2243 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002244
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002245 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002246 {
2247 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002248 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002249 if (!SI) {
2250 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002251 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002252 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002253 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002254 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2255 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002256 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002257
2258 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2259 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002260 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2261 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002262 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002263 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2264 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002265 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002266 }
2267 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002268
2269 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2270 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2271 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2272 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002273
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002274 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2275 // integer add followed by a sext.
2276 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2277 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2278 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2279 Constant *CI =
2280 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2281 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2282 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2283 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2284 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2285 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2286 CI, "addconv");
2287 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2288 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2289 }
2290 }
2291
2292 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2293 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2294 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2295 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2296 // integer add will not overflow.
2297 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2298 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2299 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2300 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2301 // Insert the new integer add.
2302 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2303 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2304 "addconv");
2305 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2306 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2307 }
2308 }
2309 }
2310
2311 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2312 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2313 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2314 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2315 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2316 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2317 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2318 // instcombined.
2319 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2320 Constant *CI =
2321 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2322 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2323 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2324 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2325 // Insert the new integer add.
2326 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2327 CI, "addconv");
2328 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2329 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2330 }
2331 }
2332
2333 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2334 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2335 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2336 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2337 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2338 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2339 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2340 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2341 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2342 // Insert the new integer add.
2343 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2344 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2345 "addconv");
2346 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2347 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2348 }
2349 }
2350 }
2351
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002352 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002353}
2354
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002355Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002356 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002357
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002358 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2359 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002361
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002362 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002363 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002364 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002365
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002366 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2368 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2370
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002371 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2372 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002373 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002374 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002375
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002376 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002377 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002378 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002379 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002380
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002381 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2382 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002383 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002384 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002385 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002386 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002387 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002388 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002389 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002390 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002391 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002392 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002393 }
2394 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002395 }
2396 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2397 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2398 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002399 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002400 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002401 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002402 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002403 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002404 }
2405 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002406 }
2407 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002408 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002409
2410 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2411 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002412 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002413 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002414
2415 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2416 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2417 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002418 }
2419
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002420 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2421 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2422
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002423 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2424 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002425 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002426 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002427 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002428 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002429 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002430 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2431 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2432 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002433 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002434 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2435 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002436 }
2437
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002438 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002439 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2440 // is not used by anyone else...
2441 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002442 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002443 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002444 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2445 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2446 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2447 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002448
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002449 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002450 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002451 }
2452
2453 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2454 //
2455 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2456 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2457 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2458
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002459 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002460 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2461 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002462 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002463
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002464 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002465 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002466 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002467 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002468 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002469 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002470 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2471
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002472 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002473 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002474 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002475 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002476 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002477 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002478
2479 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2480 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2481 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2482 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2483 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2484 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002485 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002486 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002487 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002488 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002489 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002490 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002491
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002492 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002493 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002494 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002495 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2496 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2497 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2498 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002499 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2500 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002501 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002502 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002503 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002504
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002505 ConstantInt *C1;
2506 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002507 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002508 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002509
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002510 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2511 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002512 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002513 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002514 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002515}
2516
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002517/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2518/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2519/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2520/// signed.
2521static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2522 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002523 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002524 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2525 TrueIfSigned = true;
2526 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002527 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2528 TrueIfSigned = true;
2529 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2531 TrueIfSigned = false;
2532 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2534 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2535 TrueIfSigned = true;
2536 return RHS->getValue() ==
2537 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2539 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2540 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002541 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002542 default:
2543 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002544 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002545}
2546
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002547Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002548 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002549 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002550
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002551 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2553
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002554 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002555 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2556 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002557
2558 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002559 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002560 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2561 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002562 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002563 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002564
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002565 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002566 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2567 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2569 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002570 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002571
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002572 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002573 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002574 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002575 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002576 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002577 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002578 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002580
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002581 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2582 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002583 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2584 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2585 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2586 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2588
2589 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2590 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2591 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2592 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002594 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002595
2596 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2597 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002598 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002599 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002600 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002601 Op1, "tmp");
2602 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2603 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2604 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002605 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002606
2607 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002608
2609 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2610 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002611 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002612 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002613
2614 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2615 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2616 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002617 }
2618
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002619 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2620 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002621 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002622
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002623 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2624 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2625
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002626 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2627 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2628 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2629 // formed.
2630 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002631 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002632 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002633 BoolCast = CI;
2634 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002635 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002636 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002637 BoolCast = CI;
2638 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002639 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002640 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2641 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002642 bool TIS = false;
2643
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002644 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002645 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2646 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002647 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2648 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002649 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002650 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002651 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002652 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002653 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002654 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002655 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2656 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002657
2658 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2659 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002660 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002661 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2662 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002663 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2664 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2665 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2666 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2667 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002668
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002669 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002670 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002671 }
2672 }
2673 }
2674
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002675 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002676}
2677
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002678/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2679/// instruction.
2680bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2681 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2682
2683 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2684 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2685 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2686 if (ST->isNullValue())
2687 NonNullOperand = 2;
2688 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2689 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2690 if (ST->isNullValue())
2691 NonNullOperand = 1;
2692
2693 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2694 return false;
2695
2696 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2697
2698 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2699 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2700
2701 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2702 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2703 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2704 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2705 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2706
2707 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2708 // early exit.
2709 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2710 return true;
2711
2712 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2713 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2714
2715 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2716 --BBI;
2717 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2718 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2719 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2720 break;
2721
2722 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2723 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2724 I != E; ++I) {
2725 if (*I == SI) {
2726 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2727 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2728 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2729 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2730 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2731 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2732 }
2733 }
2734
2735 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2736 if (&*BBI == SI)
2737 SI = 0;
2738 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2739 SelectCond = 0;
2740
2741 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2742 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2743 break;
2744
2745 }
2746 return true;
2747}
2748
2749
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002750/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2751/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2752/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2753/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002754Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002755 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002756
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002757 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2758 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2759 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2760 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2761 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002762 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002763 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002764
2765 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002766 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002768
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002769 return 0;
2770}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002771
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002772/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2773/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2774/// division instructions.
2775/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002776Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002777 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2778
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002779 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002780 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2781 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2782 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2783 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2784 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2785 }
2786
2787 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2789 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002790
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002791 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2792 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002793
2794 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2795 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2796 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2797 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002798
2799 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2800 // div X, 1 == X
2801 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2803
2804 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2805 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2806 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2807 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002808 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2810 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002811 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002812 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002813 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002814
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002815 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002816 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2817 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2818 return R;
2819 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2820 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2821 return NV;
2822 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002823 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002824
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002825 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002826 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002827 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2828 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2829
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002830 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2831 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2833
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002834 return 0;
2835}
2836
2837Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2838 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2839
2840 // Handle the integer div common cases
2841 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2842 return Common;
2843
2844 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2845 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2846 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2847 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002848 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002849 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002850 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002851 }
2852
2853 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002854 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002855 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2856 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002857 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002858 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002859 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002860 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002861 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002862 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002863 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002864 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002865 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002866 }
2867 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002868 }
2869
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002870 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2871 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002872 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002873 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002874 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002875 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002876 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002877 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002878 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002879 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2880 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002881 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002882 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2883 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2884
2885 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2886 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002887 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002888 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2889 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002890
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002891 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002892 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002893 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002894 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002895 return 0;
2896}
2897
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002898Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2899 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2900
2901 // Handle the integer div common cases
2902 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2903 return Common;
2904
2905 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2906 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2907 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002908 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002909
2910 // -X/C -> X/-C
2911 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002912 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002913 }
2914
2915 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2916 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002917 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002918 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002919 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002920 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002921 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002922 }
2923 }
2924
2925 return 0;
2926}
2927
2928Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2929 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2930}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002931
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002932/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2933/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2934/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2935/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2936Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002937 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002938
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002939 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002940 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2941 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2943
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002944 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2945 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002948 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002949 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002951
2952 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002953 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2954 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002955
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002956 return 0;
2957}
2958
2959/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2960/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2961/// remainder instructions.
2962/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2963Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2964 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2965
2966 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2967 return common;
2968
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002969 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002970 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2971 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2973
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002974 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2976
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002977 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2978 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2979 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2980 return R;
2981 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2982 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2983 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002984 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002985
2986 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2987 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2988 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2989 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2990 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2991 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002992 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002993 }
2994
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002995 return 0;
2996}
2997
2998Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2999 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3000
3001 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3002 return common;
3003
3004 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3005 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3006 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3007 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3008 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003009 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003010 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003011 }
3012
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003013 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003014 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3015 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3016 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003017 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003018 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003019 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003020 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003021 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003022 }
3023 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003024 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003025
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003026 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3027 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3028 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3029 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3030 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3031 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003032 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3033 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003034 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003035 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003036 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003037 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003038 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003039 }
3040 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003041 }
3042
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003043 return 0;
3044}
3045
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003046Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3047 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3048
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003049 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003050 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3051 return common;
3052
3053 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003054 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3055 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3056 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003057 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3058 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3059 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3060 return &I;
3061 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003062
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003063 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003064 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003065 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3066 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3067 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3068 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003069 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003070 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003071 }
3072
3073 return 0;
3074}
3075
3076Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003077 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3078}
3079
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003080// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3081// constant.
3082static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003083 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003084}
3085
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003086// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3087// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3088static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003089 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003090}
3091
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003092/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003093/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3094///
3095/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3096///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003097/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3098/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003099///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003100/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3101/// 0 A > B
3102/// 1 A == B
3103/// 2 A < B
3104///
3105/// <=> Value Definition
3106/// 000 0 Always false
3107/// 001 1 A > B
3108/// 010 2 A == B
3109/// 011 3 A >= B
3110/// 100 4 A < B
3111/// 101 5 A != B
3112/// 110 6 A <= B
3113/// 111 7 Always true
3114///
3115static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3116 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003117 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003118 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3119 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3120 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3121 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3122 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3123 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3124 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3125 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3126 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3127 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003128 // True -> 7
3129 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003130 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003131 return 0;
3132 }
3133}
3134
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003135/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3136/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3137/// predicate by reference.
3138static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3139 isOrdered = false;
3140 switch (CC) {
3141 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3142 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003143 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3144 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3145 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3146 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003147 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3148 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3149 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3150 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003151 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3152 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003153 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3154 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003155 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003156 default:
3157 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3158 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3159 return 0;
3160 }
3161}
3162
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003163/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3164/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003165/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003166/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003167static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3168 switch (code) {
3169 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003170 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003171 case 1:
3172 if (sign)
3173 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3174 else
3175 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3176 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3177 case 3:
3178 if (sign)
3179 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3180 else
3181 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3182 case 4:
3183 if (sign)
3184 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3185 else
3186 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3187 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3188 case 6:
3189 if (sign)
3190 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3191 else
3192 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003193 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003194 }
3195}
3196
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003197/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3198/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3199/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3200static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3201 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3202 switch (code) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003203 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003204 case 0:
3205 if (isordered)
3206 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3207 else
3208 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3209 case 1:
3210 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003211 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3212 else
3213 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003214 case 2:
3215 if (isordered)
3216 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3217 else
3218 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003219 case 3:
3220 if (isordered)
3221 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3222 else
3223 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3224 case 4:
3225 if (isordered)
3226 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3227 else
3228 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3229 case 5:
3230 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003231 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3232 else
3233 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3234 case 6:
3235 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003236 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3237 else
3238 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003239 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003240 }
3241}
3242
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003243/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3244/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003245static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3246 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003247 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3248 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003249}
3250
3251namespace {
3252// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3253struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003254 InstCombiner &IC;
3255 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003256 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3257 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3258 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3259 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003260 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003261 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3262 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003263 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3264 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003265 return false;
3266 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003267 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3268 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3269 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3270 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3271 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003272 }
3273
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003274 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003275 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003276 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003277 unsigned Code;
3278 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3279 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3280 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3281 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003282 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003283 }
3284
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003285 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3286 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3287
3288 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003289 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3290 return I;
3291 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3292 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3293 }
3294};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003295} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003296
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003297// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3298// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003299// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003300Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003301 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3302 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003303 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3304 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003305 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003306 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003307 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003308
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003309 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3310 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003311 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003312 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003313 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003314 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003315 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003316 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003317 }
3318 break;
3319 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003320 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3321 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003322
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003323 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3324 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003325 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003326 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003327 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003328 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003329 }
3330 break;
3331 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003332 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003333 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3334 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3335 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003336 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003337
3338 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003339 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003340 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3341 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3342 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003343 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003344
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003345 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3346 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3347 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3348 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3349 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3350 // no effect.
3351 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3352 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3353 return &TheAnd;
3354 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003355 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003356 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003357 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003358 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003359 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003360 }
3361 }
3362 }
3363 }
3364 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003365
3366 case Instruction::Shl: {
3367 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3368 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3369 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003370 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003371 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003372 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3373 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003374
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003375 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3376 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003377 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3378 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003379 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3380 return &TheAnd;
3381 }
3382 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003383 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003384 case Instruction::LShr:
3385 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003386 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3387 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3388 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3389 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003390 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003391 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003392 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3393 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003394
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003395 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3396 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003397 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3398 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3399 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3400 return &TheAnd;
3401 }
3402 break;
3403 }
3404 case Instruction::AShr:
3405 // Signed shr.
3406 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3407 // with an and.
3408 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003409 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003410 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003411 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3412 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003413 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003414 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003415 // Make the argument unsigned.
3416 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003417 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003418 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003419 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003420 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003421 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003422 }
3423 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003424 }
3425 return 0;
3426}
3427
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003428
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003429/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3430/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003431/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3432/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003433/// insert new instructions.
3434Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003435 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3436 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003437 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003438 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003439 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003440
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003441 if (Inside) {
3442 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003443 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003444
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003445 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003446 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003447 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003448 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3449 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3450 }
3451
3452 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3453 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003454 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003455 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003456 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3457 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003458 }
3459
3460 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003461 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003462
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003463 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003464 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003465 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003466 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3467 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3468 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3469 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003470
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003471 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3472 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3473 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003474 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003475 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003476 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3477 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003478}
3479
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003480// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3481// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3482// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3483// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003484static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003485 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003486 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3487 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003488
3489 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003490 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003491 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003492 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003493 return true;
3494}
3495
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003496/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3497/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3498/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003499///
3500/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3501/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3502/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3503///
3504/// return (A +/- B).
3505///
3506Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003507 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003508 Instruction &I) {
3509 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3510 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3511 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3512
3513 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3514
3515 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3516 default: return 0;
3517 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003518 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003519 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003520 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3521 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3522 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003523 break;
3524
3525 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3526 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3527 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003528 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003529 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003530 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003531 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003532 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003533 break;
3534 }
3535 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003536 return 0;
3537 case Instruction::Or:
3538 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003539 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003540 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3541 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003542 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003543 break;
3544 return 0;
3545 }
3546
3547 Instruction *New;
3548 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003549 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003550 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003551 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003552 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3553}
3554
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003555Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003556 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003557 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003558
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003559 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3561
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003562 // and X, X = X
3563 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003565
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003566 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003567 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003568 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003569 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3570 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3571 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003572 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003573 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003574 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003575 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003576 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003578 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003580 }
3581 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003582
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003583 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003584 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3585 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003586
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003587 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003588 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003589 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003590 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3591 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3592 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3593 case Instruction::Xor:
3594 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003595 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3596 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3597 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3598 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003599 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003600 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3601 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003602 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003603 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003604 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003605 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003606 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3607 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003608 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003609 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3610 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003611 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003612 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3613 }
3614 }
3615
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003616 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003617 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003618 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3619 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3620 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3621 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003622 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003623 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003624 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003625 break;
3626
3627 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003628 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3629 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3630 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3631 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003632 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003633
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003634 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3635 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3636 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3637 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3638 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3639 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3640
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003641 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003642 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3643 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003644 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3645 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3646 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3647 }
3648 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003649 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003650
3651 case Instruction::Shl:
3652 case Instruction::LShr:
3653 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3654 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003655 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003656 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3657 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3658 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3659 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3660 }
3661 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003662 }
3663
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003664 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003665 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003666 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003667 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003668 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3669 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3670 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3671 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003672 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003673 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003674 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003675 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3676 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003677 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3678 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3679 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003680 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003681 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3682 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003683 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003684 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003685 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003686 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003687 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003688 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3689 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3690 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003691 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003692 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3693 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3694 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003695 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003696 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003697 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003698
3699 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3700 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003701 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003702 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003703 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3704 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3705 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003706 }
3707
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003708 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3709 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003710
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003711 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3713
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003714 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003715 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003716 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003717 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003718 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003719 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003720 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003721
3722 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003723 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3724 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003725 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3726 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003727
3728 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3729 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3730 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003731 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003732 }
3733 }
3734
3735 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003736 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3737 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003738
3739 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3740 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3741 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003742 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003743 }
3744 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003745
3746 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3747 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3748 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3749 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3750 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3751 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3752 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3753 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3754 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3755 }
3756 }
3757 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3758 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3759 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3760 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3761 std::swap(A, B);
3762 }
3763 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003764 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003765 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003766 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003767 }
3768 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003769 }
3770
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003771 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3772 // where C is a power of 2
3773 Value *A, *B;
3774 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003775 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3776 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003777 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3778 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3779 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3780 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3781 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3782 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3783 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3784 }
3785 }
3786
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003787 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3788 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3789 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003790 return R;
3791
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00003792 Value *Val;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003793 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003794 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003795 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3796 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) &&
3797 match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Specific(Val), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))) &&
3798
3799 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3800 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3801 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3802 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3803 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003804
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003805 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3806 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
3807 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
3808 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3809 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3810 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3811 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3812 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3813 else
3814 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3815
3816 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3817 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
3818 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
3819 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3820 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3821 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3822 }
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003823
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003824 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3825 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3826 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3827 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3828 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3829 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3830 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003831
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003832 switch (LHSCC) {
3833 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3834 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3835 switch (RHSCC) {
3836 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3837 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3838 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3839 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3841 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3842 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3843 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003845 }
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003846 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3847 switch (RHSCC) {
3848 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3849 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3850 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3851 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
3852 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3853 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3854 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3855 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
3856 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3857 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3858 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3861 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3862 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
3863 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3864 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
3865 Val->getName()+".off");
3866 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
3867 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3868 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
3869 }
3870 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3871 }
3872 break;
3873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3874 switch (RHSCC) {
3875 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3876 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
3878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3880 break;
3881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3883 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3885 break;
3886 }
3887 break;
3888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3889 switch (RHSCC) {
3890 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3891 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3892 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
3893 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3895 break;
3896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3898 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3900 break;
3901 }
3902 break;
3903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3904 switch (RHSCC) {
3905 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3907 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3908 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3909 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3910 break;
3911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3912 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3913 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3914 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3916 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false, true, I);
3917 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3918 break;
3919 }
3920 break;
3921 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3922 switch (RHSCC) {
3923 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3924 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3925 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3927 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3928 break;
3929 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3930 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3931 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3932 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3933 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3934 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true, true, I);
3935 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3936 break;
3937 }
3938 break;
3939 }
3940 }
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003941 }
3942
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003943 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003944 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3945 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3946 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3947 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003948 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003949 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003950 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3951 I.getType(), TD) &&
3952 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3953 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003954 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003955 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3956 I.getName());
3957 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003958 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003959 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003960 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003961
3962 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003963 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3964 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3965 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003966 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3967 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3968 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003969 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003970 SI1->getOperand(0),
3971 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003972 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003973 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003974 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003975 }
3976
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003977 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003978 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3979 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3980 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003981 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3982 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003983 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3984 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3985 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3986 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003987 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3989 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3990 RHS->getOperand(0));
3991 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003992 } else {
3993 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
3994 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
3995 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
3996 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003997 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
3998 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
3999 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4000 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4001 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004002 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4003 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4004 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4005 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4006 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
4007 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4008 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4009 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4011 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4013 bool Op0Ordered;
4014 bool Op1Ordered;
4015 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4016 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4017 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4018 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4019 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4020 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4021 }
4022 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4023 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4024 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4025 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4026 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4027 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4028 // uno && ord -> false
4029 if (!Op0Ordered)
4030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4031 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4032 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4033 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4034 }
4035 }
4036 }
4037 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004038 }
4039 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004040
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004041 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004042}
4043
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004044/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4045/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4046/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4047/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4048/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4049/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4050/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4051/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4052/// match.
4053///
4054/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4055/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4056/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4057/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4058/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4059/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4060///
4061/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4062/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4063/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4064/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4065/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4066///
4067static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4068 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4069 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4070 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4071 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4072 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4073 ByteValues) ||
4074 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4075 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004076 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004077
4078 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4079 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4080 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4081 unsigned ShAmt =
4082 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4083 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4084 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4085 return true;
4086
4087 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4088 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4089 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4090 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4091 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4092 } else {
4093 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4094 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4095 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004096 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004097 }
4098
4099 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4100 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4101
4102 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4103 ByteValues);
4104 }
4105
4106 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4107 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4108 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4109 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4110 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4111 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4112 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4113 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4114
4115 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4116 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4117 // the and mask is.
4118 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4119 continue;
4120
4121 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4122 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4123 if (MaskB == 0) {
4124 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4125 continue;
4126 }
4127
4128 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4129 if (MaskB != Byte)
4130 return true;
4131
4132 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4133 }
4134
4135 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4136 ByteValues);
4137 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004138 }
4139
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004140 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4141 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4142 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4143 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4144 // their ultimate destination.
4145 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4146 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004147
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004148 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4149 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4150 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4151 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4152 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4153 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4154 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4155 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4156 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4157 return true;
4158 } else {
4159 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4160 return true;
4161 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004162
4163 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4164 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004165 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004166 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004167 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004168 return false;
4169}
4170
4171/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4172/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4173Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004174 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004175 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4176 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4177 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004178 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004179
4180 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4181 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004182 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004183 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004184
4185 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004186 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4187 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004188 return 0;
4189
4190 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4191 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4192 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4193
4194 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4195 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4196 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4197 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004198 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004199 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004200 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004201 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004202}
4203
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004204/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4205/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4206/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4207static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
4208 Value *C, Value *D) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004209 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004210 Value *Cond = 0;
Chris Lattner321e6a62008-11-16 04:33:38 +00004211 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst(m_Value(Cond), -1, 0)))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004212 return 0;
4213
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004214 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004215 if (match(D, m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), 0, -1)))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004216 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004217 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), -1, 0))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004218 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4219 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004220 if (match(B, m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), 0, -1)))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004221 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004222 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), -1, 0))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004223 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004224 return 0;
4225}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004226
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004227Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004228 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004229 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004230
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004231 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004232 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004233
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004234 // or X, X = X
4235 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004236 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004237
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004238 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4239 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004240 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4241 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4242 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4243 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4244 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4245 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004246 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4247 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4248 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4249 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004251 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004252
4253
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004254
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004255 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004256 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004257 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004258 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4259 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004260 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004261 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004262 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004263 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004264 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004265 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004266
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004267 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4268 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004269 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004270 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004271 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004272 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004273 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004274 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004275
4276 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4277 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004278 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004279 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004280 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4281 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4282 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004283 }
4284
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004285 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4286 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004287
4288 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4289 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4290 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4291 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4292 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4294
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004295 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4296 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004297 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004298 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4299 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4300 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004301 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4302 return BSwap;
4303 }
4304
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004305 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4306 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004307 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004308 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004309 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4310 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004311 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004312 }
4313
4314 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4315 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004316 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004317 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004318 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4319 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004320 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004321 }
4322
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004323 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004324 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004325 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4326 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004327 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4328 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4329 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4330 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4331 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4332 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4333 // replace with V+N.
4334 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4335 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4336 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4337 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4338 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4339 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4340 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4341 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4342 }
4343 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4344 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4345 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4346 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4347 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4349 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4351 }
4352 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004353 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004354 }
4355
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004356 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4357 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004358 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4359 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4360 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4361 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4362 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4363 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4364 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4365 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4366 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4367
4368 if (V1) {
4369 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004370 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4371 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004372 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004373 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004374
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004375 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004376 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D))
4377 return Match;
4378 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C))
4379 return Match;
4380 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D))
4381 return Match;
4382 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C))
4383 return Match;
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004384 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004385
4386 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004387 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4388 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4389 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004390 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4391 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4392 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004393 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004394 SI1->getOperand(0),
4395 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004396 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004397 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004398 }
4399 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004400
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004401 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4402 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004403 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004404 } else {
4405 A = 0;
4406 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004407 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004408 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4409 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004410 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004411
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004412 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004413 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004414 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004415 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004416 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004417 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004418 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004419
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004420 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4421 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4422 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004423 return R;
4424
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004425 Value *Val;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004426 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004427 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004428 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4429 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) &&
4430 match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Specific(Val), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))) &&
4431
4432 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4433 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4434 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4435 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4436 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4437
4438 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4439 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
4440 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4441 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
4442 bool NeedsSwap;
4443 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) ? ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)
4444 : ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
4445 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4446 else
4447 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4448
4449 if (NeedsSwap) {
4450 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4451 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4452 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4453 }
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004454
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004455 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4456 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4457 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4458 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4459 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4460 // equal.
4461 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004462
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004463 switch (LHSCC) {
4464 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4465 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4466 switch (RHSCC) {
4467 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4468 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4469 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) { // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4470 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
4471 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
4472 Val->getName()+".off");
4473 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
4474 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
4475 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004476 }
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004477 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4478 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4479 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4480 break;
4481 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4482 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4483 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004485 }
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00004486 break;
4487 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4488 switch (RHSCC) {
4489 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4491 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4492 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4493 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4494 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4495 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4496 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4498 }
4499 break;
4500 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4501 switch (RHSCC) {
4502 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4503 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4504 break;
4505 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4506 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4507 // this can cause overflow.
4508 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4509 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4510 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false, false, I);
4511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4512 break;
4513 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4514 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4515 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4516 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4517 break;
4518 }
4519 break;
4520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4521 switch (RHSCC) {
4522 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4524 break;
4525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4526 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4527 // this can cause overflow.
4528 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4529 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4530 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true, false, I);
4531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4532 break;
4533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4534 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4535 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4536 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4537 break;
4538 }
4539 break;
4540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4541 switch (RHSCC) {
4542 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4543 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4544 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4545 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4546 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4547 break;
4548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4549 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4551 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4552 break;
4553 }
4554 break;
4555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4556 switch (RHSCC) {
4557 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4562 break;
4563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4564 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4565 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4567 break;
4568 }
4569 break;
4570 }
4571 }
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004572 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004573
4574 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004575 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004576 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004577 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004578 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4579 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4580 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4581 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4582 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4583 // generated.
4584 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4585 I.getType(), TD) &&
4586 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4587 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004588 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004589 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4590 I.getName());
4591 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004592 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004593 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004594 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004595 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004596 }
4597
4598
4599 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4600 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4601 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4602 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004603 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004604 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004605 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4606 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4607 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4608 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004609 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004610 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4611
4612 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4613 // rest.
4614 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4615 RHS->getOperand(0));
4616 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004617 } else {
4618 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4619 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4620 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4621 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4622 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4623 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4624 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4625 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4626 }
4627 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4628 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4629 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4630 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4631 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4632 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4633 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4634 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4635 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4636 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4637 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4638 bool Op0Ordered;
4639 bool Op1Ordered;
4640 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4641 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4642 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4643 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4644 // or'ed predicates.
4645 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4646 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4647 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4648 return I;
4649 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4650 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4651 }
4652 }
4653 }
4654 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004655 }
4656 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004657
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004658 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004659}
4660
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004661namespace {
4662
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004663// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4664struct XorSelf {
4665 Value *RHS;
4666 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4667 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4668 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4669 return &Xor;
4670 }
4671};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004672
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004673}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004674
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004675Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004676 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004677 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004678
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004679 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4680 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4681 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4682 // idiom (misuse).
4683 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004684 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004685 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004686
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004687 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4688 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004689 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004691 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004692
4693 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4694 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004695 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4696 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4697 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4698 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4699 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4700 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004701 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4702 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004703 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004704
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004705 // Is this a ~ operation?
4706 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4707 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4708 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4709 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4710 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4711 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4712 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4713 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4714 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004715 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004716 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4717 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4718 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004719 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004720 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004721 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004722 }
4723 }
4724 }
4725 }
4726
4727
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004728 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004729 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4730 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4731 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004732 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4733 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004734
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004735 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4736 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4737 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4738 }
4739
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004740 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4741 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4742 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4743 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4744 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4745 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4746 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4747 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4748 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4749 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4750 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4751 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4752 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4753 }
4754 }
4755 }
4756 }
4757 }
4758
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004759 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004760 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004761 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4762 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004763 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4764 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004765 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004766 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004767 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004768
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004769 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004770 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004771 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004772 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004773 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004774 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004775 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004776 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004777 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004778 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004779 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4780 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004781 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004782
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004783 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004784 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4785 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004786 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004787 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4788 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4789 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004790 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004791 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4792 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004793 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004794 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4795 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4796 return &I;
4797 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004798 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004799 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004800 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004801
4802 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4803 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004804 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004805 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004806 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4807 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4808 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004809 }
4810
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004811 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004812 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004813 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004814
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004815 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004816 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004818
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004819
4820 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4821 if (Op1I) {
4822 Value *A, *B;
4823 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4824 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004825 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004826 I.swapOperands();
4827 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004828 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004829 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004830 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004831 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004832 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4833 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4835 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4836 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4837 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004838 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004839 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004840 std::swap(A, B);
4841 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004842 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004843 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4844 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4845 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004846 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004847 }
4848
4849 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4850 if (Op0I) {
4851 Value *A, *B;
4852 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4853 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4854 std::swap(A, B);
4855 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4856 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004857 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4858 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004859 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004860 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4861 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4863 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4865 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4866 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4867 std::swap(A, B);
4868 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004869 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004870 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004871 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4872 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004873 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004874 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004875 }
4876
4877 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4878 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4879 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4880 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4881 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4882 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004883 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004884 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4885 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004886 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004887 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4888 }
4889
4890 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4891 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4892 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4893 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4894 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4895 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004896 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004897 }
4898 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4899 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4900 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4901 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004902 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004903 }
4904
4905 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4906 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4907 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4908 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4909 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4910 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4911 if (A == C)
4912 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4913 else if (A == D)
4914 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4915 else if (B == C)
4916 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4917 else if (B == D)
4918 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4919
4920 if (X) {
4921 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004922 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4923 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004924 }
4925 }
4926 }
4927
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004928 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4929 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4930 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004931 return R;
4932
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004933 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004934 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004935 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004936 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4937 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004938 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004939 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004940 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4941 I.getType(), TD) &&
4942 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4943 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004944 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004945 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4946 I.getName());
4947 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004948 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004949 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004950 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004951 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004952
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004953 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004954}
4955
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004956/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4957/// overflowed for this type.
4958static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004959 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004960 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004961
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004962 if (IsSigned)
4963 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4964 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4965 else
4966 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4967 else
4968 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004969}
4970
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004971/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
4972/// overflowed for this type.
4973static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4974 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00004975 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004976
4977 if (IsSigned)
4978 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4979 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4980 else
4981 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4982 else
4983 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
4984}
4985
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004986/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4987/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4988/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4989static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4990 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4991 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004992 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4993 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004994
4995 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004996 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004997 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004998
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004999 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5000 ++i, ++GTI) {
5001 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00005002 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005003 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5004 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5005
5006 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5007 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5008 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5009
5010 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
5011 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005012 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005013 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005014 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005015 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5016 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5017 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005018 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005019
5020 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5021 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5022 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
5023 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5024 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
5025 else {
5026 // Emit an add instruction.
5027 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005028 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005029 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005030 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005031 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005032 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005033 // Convert to correct type.
5034 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5035 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5036 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
5037 else
5038 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
5039 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
5040 }
5041 if (Size != 1) {
5042 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5043 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5044 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5045 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005046 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005047 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5048 }
5049
5050 // Emit an add instruction.
5051 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5052 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5053 cast<Constant>(Result));
5054 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005055 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005056 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005057 }
5058 return Result;
5059}
5060
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005061
5062/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5063/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5064/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5065/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5066/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5067/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5068/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5069///
5070/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5071///
5072static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5073 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005074 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5075 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5076
5077 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5078 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5079 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5080 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5081 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5082 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5083 int64_t Offset = 0;
5084 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5085 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5086 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5087 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5088
5089 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5090 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5091 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5092 } else {
5093 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5094 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5095 }
5096 } else {
5097 // Found our variable index.
5098 break;
5099 }
5100 }
5101
5102 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5103 // evaluate it the general way.
5104 if (i == e) return 0;
5105
5106 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5107 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5108 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
5109 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5110
5111 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5112 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5113 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5114 if (!CI) return 0;
5115
5116 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5117 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5118
5119 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5120 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5121 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5122 } else {
5123 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5124 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5125 }
5126 }
5127
5128 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5129 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5130 // the index.
5131 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5132 if (Offset == 0) {
5133 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5134 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5135 // computation crosses zero.
5136 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5137 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5138 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5139 return VariableIdx;
5140 }
5141
5142 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5143 // the pointer size, so get it.
5144 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5145
5146 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5147 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5148
5149 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5150 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5151 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5152 // multiple of the variable scale.
5153 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5154 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5155 return 0;
5156
5157 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5158 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5159 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005160 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005161 true /*SExt*/,
5162 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5163 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005164 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005165}
5166
5167
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005168/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005169/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005170Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5171 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5172 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005173 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005174
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005175 // Look through bitcasts.
5176 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5177 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005178
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005179 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5180 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005181 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005182 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5183 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5184 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5185
5186 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5187 if (Offset == 0)
5188 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005189 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5190 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005191 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005192 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5193 // compare the base pointer.
5194 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5195 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005196 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005197 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005198 if (IndicesTheSame)
5199 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5200 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5201 IndicesTheSame = false;
5202 break;
5203 }
5204
5205 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5206 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005207 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5208 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005209
5210 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5211 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005212 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005213 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005214
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005215 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5216 bool AllZeros = true;
5217 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5218 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5219 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5220 AllZeros = false;
5221 break;
5222 }
5223 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005224 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5225 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005226
5227 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005228 AllZeros = true;
5229 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5230 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5231 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5232 AllZeros = false;
5233 break;
5234 }
5235 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005236 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005237
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005238 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5239 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5240 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5241 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5242 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5243 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005244 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5245 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005246 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005247 NumDifferences = 2;
5248 break;
5249 } else {
5250 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5251 DiffOperand = i;
5252 }
5253 }
5254
5255 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005257 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005258 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005259
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005260 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005261 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5262 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005263 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5264 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005265 }
5266 }
5267
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005268 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005269 // the result to fold to a constant!
5270 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5271 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5272 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5273 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5274 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005275 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005276 }
5277 }
5278 return 0;
5279}
5280
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005281/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5282///
5283Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5284 Instruction *LHSI,
5285 Constant *RHSC) {
5286 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5287 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5288
5289 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5290 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005291 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005292 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5293
5294 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5295 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5296 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5297 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5298
5299 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005300 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5301 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005302 ++InputSize;
5303
5304 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5305 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5306 return 0;
5307
5308 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5309 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5310 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5311 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5312
5313 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5314 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5315 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5316 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005317 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5318 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5319 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005320 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005321 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5322 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5323 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005324 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005325 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5326 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5327 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005328 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005329 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5330 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5331 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005332 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005333 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5334 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5335 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005336 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005337 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5338 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5339 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005340 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5341 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5342 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5343 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5344 }
5345
5346 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5347
5348 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5349
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005350 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005351 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5352 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5353
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005354 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5355 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5356 // and large values.
5357 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5358 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5359 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5360 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5361 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5362 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
5363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5364 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5365 }
5366 } else {
5367 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5368 // +INF and large values.
5369 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5370 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5371 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5372 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5373 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5374 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
5375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5376 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5377 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005378 }
5379
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005380 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5381 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5382 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5383 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5384 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5385 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5386 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5387 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
5388 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5389 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5390 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005391 }
5392
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005393 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5394 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5395 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5396 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005397 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5398 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5399 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005400 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust the
5401 // compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards zero
5402 // at this point.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005403 switch (Pred) {
5404 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5405 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5406 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5407 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5408 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005409 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5410 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5411 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5412 if (RHS.isNegative())
5413 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5414 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005415 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5416 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5417 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5418 if (RHS.isNegative())
5419 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5420 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005421 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5422 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5423 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5424 if (RHS.isNegative())
5425 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5426 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5427 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005428 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5429 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5430 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5431 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5432 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5433 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005434 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5435 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5436 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5437 if (RHS.isNegative())
5438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5439 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005440 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5441 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5442 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5443 if (RHS.isNegative())
5444 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5445 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005446 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5447 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5448 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5449 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5450 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5451 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5452 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005453 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5454 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5455 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5456 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5457 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5458 break;
5459 }
5460 }
5461
5462 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5463 // comparison.
5464 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5465}
5466
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005467Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5468 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005469 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005470
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005471 // Fold trivial predicates.
5472 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5474 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5475 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5476
5477 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5478 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5479 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5480 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5481 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5482 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5483 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5485 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5486 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5487 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5488 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5489
5490 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5491 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5492 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5493 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5494 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5495 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5496 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5497 return &I;
5498
5499 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5500 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5501 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5502 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5503 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5504 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5505 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5506 return &I;
5507 }
5508 }
5509
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005510 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005511 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005512
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005513 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5514 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005515 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5516 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5517 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5518 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005520 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5521 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5522 // True if unordered.
5523 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005524 }
5525 }
5526
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005527 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5528 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5529 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005530 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5531 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5532 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5533 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5534 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5535 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005536 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005537 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5538 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5539 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5540 return NV;
5541 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005542 case Instruction::Select:
5543 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5544 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5545 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5546 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5547 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5548 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5549 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5550 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5551 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5552 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5553 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5554 I.getName()), I);
5555 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5556 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5557 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5558 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5559 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5560 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5561 I.getName()), I);
5562 }
5563 }
5564
5565 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005566 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005567 break;
5568 }
5569 }
5570
5571 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5572}
5573
5574Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5575 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5576 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5577 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5578
5579 // icmp X, X
5580 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005581 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005582 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005583
5584 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005586
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005587 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005588 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005589 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5590 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5591 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005592 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005594 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005595
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005596 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005597 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005598 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5599 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005600 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005601 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005602 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005603 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005604 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005605 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005606 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005607
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005608 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005609 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005610 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005611 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005612 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005613 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005614 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005615 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005616 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5617 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005618 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005619 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5620 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5621 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5622 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5623 }
5624 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5625 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5626 // FALL THROUGH
5627 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005628 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005629 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005630 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005631 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005632 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5633 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5634 // FALL THROUGH
5635 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5636 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5637 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5638 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5639 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005640 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005641 }
5642
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005643 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005644 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005645 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005646
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005647 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5648 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5649 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5650 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5651 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005652 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005653
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005654 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5655 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5656 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005657 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5658 default: break;
5659 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5660 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5661 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5662 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5663 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5664 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5666 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5668 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5669 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5670 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5671 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5672 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5673 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5674 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5675 }
5676
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005677 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5678 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5679 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5680 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5681
5682 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005683 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005684 bool UnusedBit;
5685 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5686
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005687 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5688 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5689 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005690 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5691 return &I;
5692
5693 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005694 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5695 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5696 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005697 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5698 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5699 else
5700 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5701
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005702 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5703 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5704 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5705 if (Min == Max)
5706 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5707 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5708 CI));
5709
5710 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5711 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5712 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005713 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5714 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5715 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5716 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5718 break;
5719 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5720 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5721 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5722 break;
5723 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005724 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005725 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005726 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005727 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005728 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5729 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5730 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5731 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5732
5733 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5734 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5735 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5736 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005737 break;
5738 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005739 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005740 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005741 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005743
5744 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5745 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5746 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5747 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5748
5749 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5750 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5751 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5752 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005753 break;
5754 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005755 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005757 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005758 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005759 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5760 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005761 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005762 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005763 break;
5764 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005765 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005766 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005767 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005769
5770 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5771 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5772 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5773 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005774 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005775 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005776 }
5777
5778 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5779 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5780 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5781 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5782 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5783 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5784 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5785 if (I.hasOneUse())
5786 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5787 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5788 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5789 return 0;
5790
5791 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5792 // can be folded into the comparison.
5793 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005794 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005795 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005796 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005797 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005798 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5799 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005800 }
5801
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005802 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005803 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5804 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5805 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005806 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5807 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005808 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005809 bool isAllZeros = true;
5810 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5811 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5812 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5813 isAllZeros = false;
5814 break;
5815 }
5816 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005817 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005818 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5819 }
5820 break;
5821
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005822 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005823 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5824 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5825 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5826 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5827 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5828 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005829 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005830 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005831 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5832 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5833 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5834 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5835 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5836 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5837 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005838 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5839 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5840 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5841 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5842 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005843 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5844 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005845 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5846 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5847 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5848 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5849 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005850 }
5851 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005852
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005853 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005854 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005855 break;
5856 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005857 case Instruction::Malloc:
5858 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5859 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5860 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5861 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005863 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005864 }
5865 break;
5866 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005867 }
5868
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005869 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005870 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005871 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005872 return NI;
5873 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005874 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5875 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005876 return NI;
5877
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005878 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005879 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5880 // now.
5881 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5882 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5883 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005884 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5885 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005886 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005887
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005888 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5889 // so eliminate it as well.
5890 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5891 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005892
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005893 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005894 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005895 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005896 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005897 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005898 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005899 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005900 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005901 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005902 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005903 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005904 }
5905
5906 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005907 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005908 // This comes up when you have code like
5909 // int X = A < B;
5910 // if (X) ...
5911 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005912 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5913 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005914 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005915 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005916 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005917
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005918 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5919 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5920 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005921 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5922 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5923 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005924 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005925 default: break;
5926 case Instruction::Add:
5927 case Instruction::Sub:
5928 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005929 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5930 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5931 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005932 break;
5933 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005934 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5935 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5936 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5937 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5938 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5939 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5940 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5941 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005942 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005943 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5944 Mask);
5945 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5946 Mask);
5947 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5948 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5949 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005950 }
5951 }
5952 break;
5953 }
5954 }
5955 }
5956 }
5957
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005958 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5959 { Value *A, *B;
5960 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5961 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5962 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5963 }
5964
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005965 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005966 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005967
5968 // -x == -y --> x == y
5969 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5970 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5971 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5972
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005973 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5974 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5975 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5976 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5977 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5978 }
5979
5980 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5981 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5982 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5983 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5984 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005985 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005986 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005987 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5988 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5989 }
5990
5991 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5992 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5993 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5994 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5995 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5996 }
5997 }
5998
5999 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6000 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006001 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6002 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006003 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6004 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006005 }
6006 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006007 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006008 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6009 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006010 }
6011 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006012 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006013 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6014 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006015 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006016
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006017 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6018 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
6019 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6020 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6021 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6022
6023 if (A == C) {
6024 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6025 } else if (A == D) {
6026 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6027 } else if (B == C) {
6028 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6029 } else if (B == D) {
6030 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6031 }
6032
6033 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006034 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6035 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006036 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
6037 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
6038 return &I;
6039 }
6040 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006041 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006042 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006043}
6044
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006045
6046/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6047/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6048Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6049 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6050 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6051 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6052
6053 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6054 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6055 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6056 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6057 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6058 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6059 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6060 // if it finds it.
6061 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6062 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6063 return 0;
6064 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006065 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006066 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6067 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6068 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6069 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6070 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006071
6072 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6073 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6074 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6075 // instead of computing a divide.
6076 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
6077
6078 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6079 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6080 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
6081 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6082 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
6083
6084 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006085 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006086
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006087 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6088 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6089 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6090 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6091 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6092 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6093 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6094 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
6095 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
6096
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006097 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006098 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006099 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006100 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6101 if (!HiOverflow)
6102 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006103 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006104 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006105 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006106 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6107 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006108 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006109 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6110 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6111 if (!HiOverflow)
6112 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006113 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006114 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006115 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006116 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6117 if (!LoOverflow) {
6118 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6119 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6120 true) ? -1 : 0;
6121 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006122 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006123 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006124 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006125 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006126 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6127 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006128 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6129 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6130 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6131 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006132 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006133 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006134 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006135 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006136 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006137 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006138 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006139 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6140 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006141 if (!HiOverflow)
6142 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006143 }
6144
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006145 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6146 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006147 }
6148
6149 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006150 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006151 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6152 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6153 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6154 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6155 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006156 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006157 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6158 else if (LoOverflow)
6159 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6160 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6161 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006162 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006163 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6164 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6166 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006167 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006168 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6169 else if (LoOverflow)
6170 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6171 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6172 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006173 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006174 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6175 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006176 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6178 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006180 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006181 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6182 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006183 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006184 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006185 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6187 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006188 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6189 else
6190 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6191 }
6192}
6193
6194
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006195/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6196///
6197Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6198 Instruction *LHSI,
6199 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6200 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6201
6202 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006203 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006204 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6205 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6206 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006207 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6208 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006209 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6210
6211 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6212 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6213 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6214 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6215 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6216 return &ICI;
6217 }
6218
6219 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6220 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6221
6222 // If so, the new one isn't.
6223 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6224
6225 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6226 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6227 else
6228 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6229 }
6230 }
6231 break;
6232 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6233 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6234 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6235 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6236
6237 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6238 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6239 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6240 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6241 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6242 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6243 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6244 // bit would not work.
6245 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006246 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6247 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006248 uint32_t BitWidth =
6249 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6250 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6251 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6252 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6253 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6254 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006255 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006256 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6257 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6258 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6259 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6260 }
6261 }
6262
6263 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6264 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6265 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6266 // access.
6267 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6268 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6269 Shift = 0;
6270
6271 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6272 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6273 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6274 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6275
6276 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6277 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6278 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6279 if (ShAmt) {
6280 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6281 if (!CanFold) {
6282 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6283 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6284 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6285 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6286
6287 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6288 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6289 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6290 CanFold = true;
6291 }
6292
6293 if (CanFold) {
6294 Constant *NewCst;
6295 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6296 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6297 else
6298 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6299
6300 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6301 // compared.
6302 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6303 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6304 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6305 // result is always true or false now.
6306 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6308 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6309 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6310 } else {
6311 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6312 Constant *NewAndCST;
6313 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6314 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6315 else
6316 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6317 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6318 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6319 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6320 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6321 return &ICI;
6322 }
6323 }
6324 }
6325
6326 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6327 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6328 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6329 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6330 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6331 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6332 // Compute C << Y.
6333 Value *NS;
6334 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006335 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006336 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6337 } else {
6338 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006339 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006340 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6341 }
6342 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6343
6344 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6345 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006346 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006347 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6348
6349 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6350 return &ICI;
6351 }
6352 }
6353 break;
6354
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006355 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6356 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6357 if (!ShAmt) break;
6358
6359 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6360
6361 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6362 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6363 // simplified.
6364 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6365 break;
6366
6367 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6368 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6369 // comparison cannot succeed.
6370 Constant *Comp =
6371 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6372 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6373 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6374 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6376 }
6377
6378 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6379 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6380 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6381 Constant *Mask =
6382 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006383
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006384 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006385 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006386 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6387 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6388 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6389 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006390 }
6391 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006392
6393 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6394 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6395 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6396 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6397 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6398 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6399 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6400 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006401 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006402 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6403 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6404
6405 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6406 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6407 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006408 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006409 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006410
6411 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006412 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006413 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006414 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006415 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006416
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006417 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6418 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6419 // simplified.
6420 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6421 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6422 break;
6423
6424 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006425
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006426 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6427 // comparison cannot succeed.
6428 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6429 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6430 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6431 else
6432 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6433
6434 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6435 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6436 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6438 }
6439
6440 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6441 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6442 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006443 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6444 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006445 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6446 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6447 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6448 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006449
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006450 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006451 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6452 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6453 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006454
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006455 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006456 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006457 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6458 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6459 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6460 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006461 }
6462 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006463 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006464
6465 case Instruction::SDiv:
6466 case Instruction::UDiv:
6467 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6468 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6469 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6470 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6471 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6472 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006473 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6474 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6475 DivRHS))
6476 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006477 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006478
6479 case Instruction::Add:
6480 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6481
6482 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6483 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6484 if (!LHSC) break;
6485 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6486
6487 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6488 .subtract(LHSV);
6489
6490 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6491 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6492 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6493 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6494 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6495 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6496 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6497 }
6498 } else {
6499 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6500 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6501 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6502 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6503 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6504 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6505 }
6506 }
6507 }
6508 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006509 }
6510
6511 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6512 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6513 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6514
6515 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6516 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6517 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6518 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6519 case Instruction::SRem:
6520 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6521 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6522 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6523 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6524 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006525 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006526 BO->getName());
6527 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6528 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6529 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6530 }
6531 }
6532 break;
6533 case Instruction::Add:
6534 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6535 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6536 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6537 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6538 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6539 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6540 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6541 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6542 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6543
6544 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6545 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6546 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6547 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6548 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006549 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006550 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6551 Neg->takeName(BO);
6552 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6553 }
6554 }
6555 break;
6556 case Instruction::Xor:
6557 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6558 // the explicit xor.
6559 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6560 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6561 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6562
6563 // FALLTHROUGH
6564 case Instruction::Sub:
6565 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6566 if (RHSV == 0)
6567 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6568 BO->getOperand(1));
6569 break;
6570
6571 case Instruction::Or:
6572 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6573 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6574 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6575 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6576 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6578 isICMP_NE));
6579 }
6580 break;
6581
6582 case Instruction::And:
6583 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6584 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6585 // comparison can never succeed!
6586 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6588 isICMP_NE));
6589
6590 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6591 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6592 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6593 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6594 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6595
6596 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006597 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006598 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6599 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6600 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6601 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6602 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6603 }
6604
6605 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6606 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6607 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6608 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6609 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6610 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6611 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6612 }
6613 }
6614 default: break;
6615 }
6616 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6617 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6618 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6619 AddToWorkList(II);
6620 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6621 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6622 return &ICI;
6623 }
6624 }
6625 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006626 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6627 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006628 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6629 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6630 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6631 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6632 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6633 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6634 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6635 // smaller constant values.
6636 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6637 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6638 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6639 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6640 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6641 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6642 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6643 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6644 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6645 }
6646 }
6647 }
6648 }
6649 return 0;
6650}
6651
6652/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6653/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6654///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006655Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6656 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006657 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6658 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006659 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006660 Value *RHSCIOp;
6661
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006662 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6663 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6664 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6665 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6666 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6667 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6668 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006669 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006670 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6671 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6672 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6673 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006674 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006675 }
6676
6677 if (RHSOp)
6678 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6679 }
6680
6681 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6682 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006683 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6684 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006685 return 0;
6686
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006687 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6688 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006689
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006690 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006691 // Not an extension from the same type?
6692 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006693 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6694 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006695
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006696 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006697 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6698 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6699 return 0;
6700
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006701 // Deal with equality cases early.
6702 if (ICI.isEquality())
6703 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6704
6705 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6706 // signed comparison.
6707 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6708 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6709
6710 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6711 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006712 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006713
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006714 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6715 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6716 if (!CI)
6717 return 0;
6718
6719 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6720 // reextended to DestTy.
6721 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6722 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6723
6724 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6725 if (Res2 == CI) {
6726 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6727 // For example, we might have:
6728 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6729 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6730 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6731 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6732 // because %A may have negative value.
6733 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006734 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6735 // signless.
6736 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006737 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006738 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006739 }
6740
6741 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6742 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6743
6744 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6745 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6746 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006748 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006749 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006750
6751 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6752 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6753 Value *Result;
6754 if (isSignedCmp) {
6755 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006756 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006757 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006758 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006759 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006760 } else {
6761 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6762 if (isSignedExt) {
6763 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6764 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006765 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006766 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6767 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6768 } else {
6769 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006770 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006771 }
6772 }
6773
6774 // Finally, return the value computed.
6775 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006776 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006777 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006778
6779 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6780 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6781 "ICmp should be folded!");
6782 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6784 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006785}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006786
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006787Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6788 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6789}
6790
6791Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6792 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6793}
6794
6795Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006796 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6797 return R;
6798
6799 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6800
6801 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6802 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6803 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6804 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6805
6806 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006807 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6808 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006809 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006810 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006811
6812 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006813}
6814
6815Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6816 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006817 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006818
6819 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6820 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006821 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006822 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006824
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006825 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6826 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006827 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006828 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006829 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6830 }
6831 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006832 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6833 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6834 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006836 }
6837
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006838 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6839 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6840 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006841 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006842 return R;
6843
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006844 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006845 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6846 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006847 return 0;
6848}
6849
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006850Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006851 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006852 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006853
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006854 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6855 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006856 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6857 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6858 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006859 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6860 return &I;
6861
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006862 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6863 // of a signed value.
6864 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006865 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006866 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6868 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006869 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006870 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006871 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006872 }
6873
6874 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6875 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6876 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6877 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006878 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006879 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6880
6881 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6882 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6883 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6884 return R;
6885 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6886 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6887 return NV;
6888
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006889 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6890 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6891 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6892 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6893 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6894 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6895 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6896 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6897 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6898 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6899 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6900 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006901 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006902 I.getName());
6903 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6904
6905 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6906 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6907 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6908 // other xforms later if dead.
6909 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6910 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6911 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6912
6913 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6914 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6915 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6916 // mask as appropriate.
6917 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6918 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6919 else {
6920 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6921 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6922 }
6923
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006924 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006925 TI->getName());
6926 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6927
6928 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6929 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6930 }
6931 }
6932
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006933 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006934 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6935 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6936 Value *V1, *V2;
6937 ConstantInt *CC;
6938 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006939 default: break;
6940 case Instruction::Add:
6941 case Instruction::And:
6942 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006943 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006944 // These operators commute.
6945 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006946 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6947 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006948 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006949 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006950 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006951 Op0BO->getName());
6952 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006953 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006954 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006955 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006956 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006957 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006958 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006959 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006960 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006961
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006962 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006963 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006964 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006965 match(Op0BOOp1,
6966 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006967 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6968 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006969 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006970 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6971 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006972 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6973 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006974 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006975 V1->getName()+".mask");
6976 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6977
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006978 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006979 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006980 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006981
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006982 // FALL THROUGH.
6983 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006984 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006985 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6986 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006987 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006988 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006989 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6990 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006991 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006992 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006993 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006994 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006995 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006996 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006997 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006998 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006999 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007000
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007001 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007002 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7003 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7004 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007005 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007006 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7007 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007008 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007009 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7010 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007011 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7012 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007013 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007014 V1->getName()+".mask");
7015 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7016
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007017 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007018 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007019
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007020 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007021 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007022 }
7023
7024
7025 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7026 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7027 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7028 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7029 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7030
7031 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007032 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007033 case Instruction::Add:
7034 isValid = isLeftShift;
7035 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007036 case Instruction::Or:
7037 case Instruction::Xor:
7038 highBitSet = false;
7039 break;
7040 case Instruction::And:
7041 highBitSet = true;
7042 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007043 }
7044
7045 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7046 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7047 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7048 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7049 // operation.
7050 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007051 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007052 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007053
7054 if (isValid) {
7055 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
7056
7057 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007058 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007059 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007060 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007061
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007062 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007063 NewRHS);
7064 }
7065 }
7066 }
7067 }
7068
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007069 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007070 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7071 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7072 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007073
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007074 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007075 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007076 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7077 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007078 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7079 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7080 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007081
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007082 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00007083 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
7084 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007085
7086 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7087
7088 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007089 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007090 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007091 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
7092 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7093 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
7094 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007095 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007096 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7097 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7098 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7099 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007100 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007101 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7102
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007103 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007104 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007105 }
7106
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007107 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7108 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7109 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7110 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7111 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007112 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007113 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007114 }
7115 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7116 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007117 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007118 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007119 }
7120 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7121 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7122 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7123 // generators.
7124 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7125 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007126 case 1 :
7127 case 8 :
7128 case 16 :
7129 case 32 :
7130 case 64 :
7131 case 128:
7132 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7133 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007134 default: break;
7135 }
7136 if (SExtType) {
7137 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7138 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7139 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7140 }
7141 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7142 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007143 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007144
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007145 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007146 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7147 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7148 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007149 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007150 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007151 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7152
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007153 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007154 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007155 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007156
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007157 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007158 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7159 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7160 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007161 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007162 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007163
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007164 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007165 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007166 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007167
7168 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7169 } else {
7170 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007171 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007172
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007173 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007174 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7175 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7176 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7177 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007178 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007179 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7180 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7181
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007182 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007183 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007184 }
7185
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007186 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007187 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7188 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7189 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007190 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007191 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7192
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007193 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007194 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007195 }
7196
7197 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007198 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007199 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007200 return 0;
7201}
7202
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007203
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007204/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7205/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7206/// X*Scale+Offset.
7207///
7208static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007209 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007210 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007211 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007212 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007213 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007214 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007215 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7216 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7217 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7218 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7219 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7220 Offset = 0;
7221 return I->getOperand(0);
7222 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7223 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7224 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7225 Offset = 0;
7226 return I->getOperand(0);
7227 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7228 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7229 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7230 unsigned SubScale;
7231 Value *SubVal =
7232 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7233 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7234 Scale = SubScale;
7235 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007236 }
7237 }
7238 }
7239
7240 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7241 Scale = 1;
7242 Offset = 0;
7243 return Val;
7244}
7245
7246
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007247/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7248/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007249Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007250 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007251 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007252
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007253 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7254 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007255
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007256 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7257 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7258 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7259 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7260 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7261
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007262 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007263 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007264 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007265 }
7266 }
7267
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007268 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7269 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7270 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7271 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007272
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007273 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7274 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007275 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7276
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007277 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7278 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7279 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7280 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7281
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007282 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7283 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007284 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007285
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007286 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7287 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007288 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7289 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007290 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7291 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7292
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007293 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7294 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007295 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7296 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007297
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007298 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7299 Value *Amt = 0;
7300 if (Scale == 1) {
7301 Amt = NumElements;
7302 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007303 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007304 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7305 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007306 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007307 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007308 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007309 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007310 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007311 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007312 }
7313
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007314 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7315 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007316 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007317 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7318 }
7319
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007320 AllocationInst *New;
7321 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007322 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007323 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007324 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007325 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007326 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007327
7328 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7329 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7330 // die soon.
7331 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7332 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007333 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7334 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7335 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007336 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7337 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7338 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007339 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7340}
7341
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007342/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007343/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7344/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7345/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7346/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7347///
7348/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7349/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007350///
7351/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7352/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7353/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7354/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7355/// efficiently truncated.
7356///
7357/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7358/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7359/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007360bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7361 unsigned CastOpc,
7362 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007363 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7364 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7365 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007366
7367 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007368 if (!I) return false;
7369
7370 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007371
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007372 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7373 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7374 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7375 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7376 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7377 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7378 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7379 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007380 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007381 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7382 return true;
7383 }
7384 }
7385
7386 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7387 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7388 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7389
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007390 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007391 case Instruction::Add:
7392 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007393 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007394 case Instruction::And:
7395 case Instruction::Or:
7396 case Instruction::Xor:
7397 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007398 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7399 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7400 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7401 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007402
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007403 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007404 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7405 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7406 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007407 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7408 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7409 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007410 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7411 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007412 }
7413 break;
7414 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007415 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7416 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7417 // already zeros.
7418 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007419 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7420 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7421 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007422 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007423 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7424 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007425 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7426 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007427 }
7428 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007429 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007430 case Instruction::ZExt:
7431 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007432 case Instruction::Trunc:
7433 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007434 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7435 // of casts in the input.
7436 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007437 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007438 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007439 case Instruction::Select: {
7440 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7441 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7442 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7443 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7444 NumCastsRemoved);
7445 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007446 case Instruction::PHI: {
7447 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7448 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7449 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7450 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7451 NumCastsRemoved))
7452 return false;
7453 return true;
7454 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007455 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007456 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7457 break;
7458 }
7459
7460 return false;
7461}
7462
7463/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7464/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7465/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007466Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007467 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007468 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007469 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007470
7471 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7472 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007473 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007474 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007475 case Instruction::Add:
7476 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007477 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007478 case Instruction::And:
7479 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007480 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007481 case Instruction::AShr:
7482 case Instruction::LShr:
7483 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007484 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007485 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007486 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007487 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007488 break;
7489 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007490 case Instruction::Trunc:
7491 case Instruction::ZExt:
7492 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007493 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007494 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7495 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007496 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7497 return I->getOperand(0);
7498
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007499 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007500 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007501 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007502 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007503 case Instruction::Select: {
7504 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7505 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7506 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7507 break;
7508 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007509 case Instruction::PHI: {
7510 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7511 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7512 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7513 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7514 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7515 }
7516 Res = NPN;
7517 break;
7518 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007519 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007520 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7521 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7522 break;
7523 }
7524
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007525 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007526 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7527}
7528
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007529/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7530Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007531 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7532
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007533 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007534 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007535 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007536 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7537 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7538 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7539 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007540 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007541 }
7542 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007543
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007544 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007545 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7546 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7547 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007548
7549 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007550 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7551 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7552 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007553
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007554 return 0;
7555}
7556
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007557/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7558Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7559 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7560
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007561 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007562 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7563 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007564 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7565 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7566 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7567 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007568 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007569 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7570 return &CI;
7571 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007572
7573 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7574 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7575 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7576 // non-type-safe code.
7577 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7578 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7579 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7580 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7581 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7582
7583 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7584 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7585 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7586 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7587 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7588 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7589
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007590 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7591 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7592 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007593 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007594 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007595 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007596 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7597 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007598
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007599 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7600 if (Offset < 0) {
7601 --FirstIdx;
7602 Offset += TySize;
7603 assert(Offset >= 0);
7604 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007605 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007606 }
7607
7608 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007609
7610 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7611 while (Offset) {
7612 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7613 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007614 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7615 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7616 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007617
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007618 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7619 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7620 } else {
7621 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7622 Offset = 0;
7623 OrigBase = 0;
7624 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007625 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7626 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007627 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007628 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7629 Offset %= EltSize;
7630 } else {
7631 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7632 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007633 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7634 } else {
7635 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7636 Offset = 0;
7637 OrigBase = 0;
7638 }
7639 }
7640 if (OrigBase) {
7641 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7642 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7643 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007644 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7645 NewIndices.begin(),
7646 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007647 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7648 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7649
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007650 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7651 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7652 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7653 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7654 }
7655 }
7656 }
7657 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007658 }
7659
7660 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7661}
7662
7663
7664
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007665/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7666/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007667/// cases.
7668/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7669Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7670 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7671 return Result;
7672
7673 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7674 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7675 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007676 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7677 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007678
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007679 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7680 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007681 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7682 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007683 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7684 return &CI;
7685
7686 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7687 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007688 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7689 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007690 return 0;
7691
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007692 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007693 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007694 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7695 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007696 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007697 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007698 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7699 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7700 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7701 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007702 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007703 bool DoXForm;
7704 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7705 default:
7706 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7707 // get here because of the check above.
7708 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7709 case Instruction::Trunc:
7710 DoXForm = true;
7711 break;
7712 case Instruction::ZExt:
7713 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7714 break;
7715 case Instruction::SExt:
7716 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7717 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007718 }
7719
7720 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007721 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7722 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007723 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7724 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7725 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7726 case Instruction::Trunc:
7727 case Instruction::BitCast:
7728 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7729 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7730 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7731 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7732 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007733 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7734 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007735 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007736 }
7737 case Instruction::SExt:
7738 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007739 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007740 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7741 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007742 }
7743 }
7744 }
7745
7746 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7747 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7748
7749 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7750 case Instruction::Add:
7751 case Instruction::Mul:
7752 case Instruction::And:
7753 case Instruction::Or:
7754 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007755 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007756 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7757 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7758 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7759 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7760 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007761 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7762 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007763 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007764 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7765 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007766 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007767 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007768 }
7769 }
7770
7771 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7772 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7773 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007774 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007775 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007776 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007777 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007778 }
7779 break;
7780 case Instruction::SDiv:
7781 case Instruction::UDiv:
7782 case Instruction::SRem:
7783 case Instruction::URem:
7784 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7785 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7786 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7787 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7788 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007789 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7790 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007791 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7792 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7793 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7794 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007795 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007796 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7797 }
7798 }
7799 break;
7800
7801 case Instruction::Shl:
7802 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7803 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7804 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7805 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7806 // in the value.
7807 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7808 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007809 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7810 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7811 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007812 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007813 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007814 }
7815 break;
7816 case Instruction::AShr:
7817 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7818 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7819 // simplifications.
7820 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7821 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007822 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007823 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7824 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007825 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007826 }
7827 }
7828 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007829 }
7830 return 0;
7831}
7832
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007833Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007834 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7835 return Result;
7836
7837 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7838 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007839 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7840 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007841
7842 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7843 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7844 default: break;
7845 case Instruction::LShr:
7846 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7847 // are already zeros.
7848 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007849 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007850
7851 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007852 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007853 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7854 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007855 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7857
7858 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7859 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007860 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7861 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7862 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007863 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007864 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007865 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7866
7867 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7868 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7869 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007870 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007871 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7872
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007873 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007874 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007875 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007876 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007877 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7878 "tmp"), CI);
7879 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007880 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007881 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007882 }
7883 break;
7884 }
7885 }
7886
7887 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007888}
7889
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007890/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7891/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7892Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7893 bool DoXform) {
7894 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7895 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7896 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7897 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7898 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7899
7900 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7901 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7902 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7903 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7904 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7905
7906 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7907 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7908 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007909 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007910 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7911 CI);
7912 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007913 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007914 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7915
7916 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7917 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007918 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007919 In->getName()+".not"),
7920 CI);
7921 }
7922
7923 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7924 }
7925
7926
7927
7928 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7929 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7930 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7931 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7932 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7933 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7934 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7935 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7936 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7937 // This only works for EQ and NE
7938 ICI->isEquality()) {
7939 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7940 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7941 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7942 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7943 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7944
7945 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7946 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7947 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7948
7949 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7950 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7951 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7952 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7953 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7954 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7956 }
7957
7958 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7959 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7960 if (ShiftAmt) {
7961 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7962 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007963 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007964 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7965 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7966 }
7967
7968 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7969 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007970 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007971 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7972 }
7973
7974 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7976 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007977 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007978 }
7979 }
7980 }
7981
7982 return 0;
7983}
7984
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007985Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007986 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7987 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7988 return Result;
7989
7990 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7991
7992 // If this is a cast of a cast
7993 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007994 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7995 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7996 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7997 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7998 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7999 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008000 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8001 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8002 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008003 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
8004 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
8005 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00008006 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00008007 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008008 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008009 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008010 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
8011 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
8012 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8013 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008014 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008015 }
8016 return And;
8017 }
8018 }
8019 }
8020
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008021 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8022 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008023
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008024 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8025 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8026 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8027 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8028 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8029 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8030 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8031 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8032 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8033 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8034 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008035 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008036 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008037 }
8038
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008039 return 0;
8040}
8041
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008042Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008043 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8044 return I;
8045
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008046 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8047
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008048 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8049 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8050 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
8051 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8052 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008053
8054 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8055 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
8056 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
8057 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
8058 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
8059 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
8060 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
8061 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8062
8063 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8064 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8065 // bits, it is already ready.
8066 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8068 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8069 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8070 // bits, just sext from i32.
8071 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8072 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8073 } else {
8074 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8075 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8076 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8077 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8078 }
8079 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008080
8081 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8082 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8083 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8084 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8085 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8086 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8087 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8088 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8089 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8090 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8091 // into:
8092 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8093 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8094 Value *A = 0;
8095 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8096 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8097 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8098 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8099 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8100 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8101 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8102 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8103 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8104 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8105 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8106 CI.getName()), CI);
8107 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8108 }
8109 }
8110
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008111 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008112}
8113
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008114/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8115/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008116static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008117 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008118 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008119 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8120 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008121 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008122 return 0;
8123}
8124
8125/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8126/// through it until we get the source value.
8127static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8128 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8129 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8130 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8131
8132 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8133 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8134 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8135 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8136 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8137 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8138 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008139 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008140 return V;
8141 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8142 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008143 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008144 return V;
8145 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8146 }
8147
8148 return V;
8149}
8150
8151Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8152 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8153 return I;
8154
8155 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8156 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8157 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8158 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8159 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8160 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8161 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8162 default: break;
8163 case Instruction::Add:
8164 case Instruction::Sub:
8165 case Instruction::Mul:
8166 case Instruction::FDiv:
8167 case Instruction::FRem:
8168 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8169 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8170 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8171 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8172 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8173 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8174 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8175 // the cast, do this xform.
8176 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8177 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8178 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8179 CI.getType(), CI);
8180 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8181 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008182 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008183 }
8184 }
8185 break;
8186 }
8187 }
8188 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008189}
8190
8191Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8192 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8193}
8194
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008195Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008196 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8197 if (OpI == 0)
8198 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8199
8200 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8201 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8202 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8203 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8204 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8205 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8206 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8207 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8208 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8209 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8210 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008211
8212 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008213}
8214
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008215Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008216 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8217 if (OpI == 0)
8218 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8219
8220 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8221 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8222 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8223 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8224 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8225 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8226 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8227 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8228 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8229 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008231
8232 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008233}
8234
8235Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8236 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8237}
8238
8239Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8240 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8241}
8242
8243Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008244 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008245}
8246
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008247Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8248 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8249 return I;
8250
8251 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8252 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8253
8254 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8255 ConstantInt *Cst;
8256 Value *X;
8257 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8258 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8259 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8260 // is a single-index GEP.
8261 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8262 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008263 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008264
8265 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8266 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8267 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8268
8269 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8270 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8271 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008272 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008273 }
8274 }
8275 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8276 // struct etc.
8277 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8278 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8279 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8280 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8281
8282 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8283 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8284
8285 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8286 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8287 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8288
8289 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8290 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8291 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8292
8293 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8294 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008295 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008296 }
8297 }
8298 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008299}
8300
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008301Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008302 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8303 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8304 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8305 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8306 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8307
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008308 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008309 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8310 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008311 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8312 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8313 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008314 } else {
8315 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8316 return Result;
8317 }
8318
8319
8320 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8321 // be replaced by the operand.
8322 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8324
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008325 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008326 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8327 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8328 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8329
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008330 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8331 // required for changing types.
8332 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8333 return 0;
8334
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008335 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8336 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8337 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8338 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8339 return V;
8340
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008341 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8342 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008343 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8344 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8345 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8346 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8347 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8348 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8349 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8350 ++NumZeros;
8351 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008352
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008353 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8354 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8355 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008356 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8357 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008358 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008359 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008360
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008361 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8362 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8363 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8364 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008365 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008366 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8367 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8368 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8369 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008370 CastInst *Tmp;
8371 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8372 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8373 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8374 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8375 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8376 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8377 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008378 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8379 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8380 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8381 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008382 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8383 // know the vector types match #elts.
8384 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008385 }
8386 }
8387 }
8388 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008389 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008390}
8391
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008392/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8393/// %C = or %A, %B
8394/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8395/// into:
8396/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8397/// %D = or %A, %C
8398///
8399/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8400/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8401/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8402///
8403static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8404 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8405 case Instruction::Add:
8406 case Instruction::Mul:
8407 case Instruction::And:
8408 case Instruction::Or:
8409 case Instruction::Xor:
8410 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8411 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8412 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008413 case Instruction::LShr:
8414 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008415 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008416 default:
8417 return 0; // Cannot fold
8418 }
8419}
8420
8421/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8422/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8423static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8424 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8425 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8426 case Instruction::Add:
8427 case Instruction::Sub:
8428 case Instruction::Or:
8429 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008430 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008431 case Instruction::LShr:
8432 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008433 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008434 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008435 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008436 case Instruction::Mul:
8437 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8438 }
8439}
8440
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008441/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8442/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8443Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8444 Instruction *FI) {
8445 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8446 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8447 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008448 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008449 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8450 return 0;
8451 } else {
8452 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8453 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008454
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008455 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008456 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8457 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008458 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008459 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008460 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008461 }
8462
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008463 // Only handle binary operators here.
8464 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008465 return 0;
8466
8467 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8468 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8469 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8470 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8471 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8472 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8473 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8474 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8475 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8476 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8477 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8478 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8479 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8480 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8481 return 0;
8482 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8483 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8484 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8485 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8486 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8487 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8488 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8489 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8490 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8491 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8492 } else {
8493 return 0;
8494 }
8495
8496 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008497 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8498 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008499 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8500
8501 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8502 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008503 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008504 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008505 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008506 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008507 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8508 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008509}
8510
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008511/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8512/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8513///
8514Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8515 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8516 bool Changed = false;
8517 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8518 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8519 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8520 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8521 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8522
8523 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8524 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8525 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8526 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008527 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008528 switch (Pred) {
8529 default: break;
8530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8532 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8533 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8534 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8535 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8536 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8537 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8538 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8539 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8540 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8541 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8542 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8543 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8544 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8545 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8546 Changed = true;
8547 }
8548 break;
8549 }
8550 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8551 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8552 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8553 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8554 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8555 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8556 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8557 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8558 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8559 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8560 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8561 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8562 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8563 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8564 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8565 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8566 Changed = true;
8567 }
8568 break;
8569 }
8570 }
8571
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008572 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
8573 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
8574 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8575 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(0)) &&
8576 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)))
8577 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
8578 else if (!match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)) ||
8579 !match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(0)))
8580 Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
8581 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
8582 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8583 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8584 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8585 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
8586
8587 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
8588 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
8589 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8590 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8591 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8592 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
8593 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
8594 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
8595 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8596 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00008597 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
8598 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008599 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
8600
8601 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
8602 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
8603 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
8604
8605 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
8606 }
8607 }
8608 }
8609
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008610 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8611 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8612 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8613 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8614 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8615 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8616 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8617 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8618
8619 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8620 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8621 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8623 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8624 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8625 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8626 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8627 }
8628
8629 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8630
8631 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8632}
8633
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008634Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008635 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8636 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8637 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8638
8639 // select true, X, Y -> X
8640 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008641 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008642 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008643
8644 // select C, X, X -> X
8645 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8646 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8647
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008648 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8650 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8651 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8652 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8653 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8655 else
8656 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8657 }
8658
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008659 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008660 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008661 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008662 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008663 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008664 } else {
8665 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8666 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008667 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008668 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008669 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008670 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008671 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008672 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008673 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008674 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008675 } else {
8676 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8677 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008678 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008679 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008680 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008681 }
8682 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008683
8684 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8685 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8686 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008687 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008688 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008689 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008690 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008691
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008692 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8693 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8694 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008695 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008696 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008697 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008698 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008699 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008700 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008701 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008702 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008703 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008704 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008705
8706 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008707
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008708 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008709
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008710 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008711 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008712 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008713 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008714 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008715 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008716 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008717 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008718 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008719 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008720 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008721 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8722
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008723 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8724 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8725 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008726 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8727 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008728 if (SRASize < SISize)
8729 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8730 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8731 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008732 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008733 }
8734 }
8735
8736
8737 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008738 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008739 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8740 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008741 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008742 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008743 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8744 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8745 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008746 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8747 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8748 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008749 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8750 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008751 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8752 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008753 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008754 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008755 Value *V = ICA;
8756 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008757 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008758 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8759 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8760 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008761 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008762 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008763
8764 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008765 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8766 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008767 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008768 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8769 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8770 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8771 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8772 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8773 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8774 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8775 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8776 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008777 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008778 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008779 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008780 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008781 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008782 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008783
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008784 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008785 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008786 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8787 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8788 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8789 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8790 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8791 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8792 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8793 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8794 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8796 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008797 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008798 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008800 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008801 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008802 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008803 }
8804
8805 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008806 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8807 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8808 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008809
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008810 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8811 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8812 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008813 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8814
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008815 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8816 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8817 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8818 return IV;
8819
8820 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8821 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008822 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8823 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8824 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8825 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8826 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8827 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8828 }
8829
8830 if (AddOp) {
8831 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8832 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8833 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8834 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8835 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8836 }
8837
8838 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008839 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8840 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8841 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8842 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8843 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8844 } else {
8845 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008846 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008847 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008848
8849 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8850 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8851 if (AddOp != TI)
8852 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8853 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008854 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8855 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008856
8857 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008858 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008859 }
8860 }
8861 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008862
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008863 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008864 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008865 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8866 // transformation we are doing here.
8867 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8868 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8869 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8870 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8871 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8872 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8873 OpToFold = 1;
8874 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8875 OpToFold = 2;
8876 }
8877
8878 if (OpToFold) {
8879 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008880 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008881 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8882 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008883 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008884 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008885 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008886 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008887 else {
8888 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8889 }
8890 }
8891 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008892
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008893 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8894 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8895 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8896 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8897 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8898 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8899 OpToFold = 1;
8900 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8901 OpToFold = 2;
8902 }
8903
8904 if (OpToFold) {
8905 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008906 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008907 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8908 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008909 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008910 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008911 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008912 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008913 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008914 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008915 }
8916 }
8917 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008918
8919 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8920 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8921 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8922 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8923 return &SI;
8924 }
8925
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008926 return 0;
8927}
8928
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008929/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8930/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8931/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8932/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8933/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8934///
8935static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8936 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008937
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008938 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8939 if (!U) return Align;
8940
8941 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8942 default: break;
8943 case Instruction::BitCast:
8944 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8945 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008946 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8947 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008948 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008949 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8950 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008951 AllZeroOperands = false;
8952 break;
8953 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008954
8955 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8956 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008957 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008958 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008959 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008960 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008961 }
8962
8963 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8964 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8965 // of the global.
8966 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8967 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8968 Align = PrefAlign;
8969 }
8970 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8971 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8972 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8973 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8974 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8975 Align = PrefAlign;
8976 }
8977 }
8978
8979 return Align;
8980}
8981
8982/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8983/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8984/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8985/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8986unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8987 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8988 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8989 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8990 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8991 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8992 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8993 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8994 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8995
8996 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8997 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8998
8999 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9000 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009001}
9002
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009003Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009004 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
9005 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009006 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
9007 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9008
9009 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
9010 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
9011 return MI;
9012 }
9013
9014 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9015 // load/store.
9016 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9017 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9018
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009019 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9020 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9021 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9022 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009023 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009024 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9025
9026 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009027 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009028
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009029 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009030 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009031
9032 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9033 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9034 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9035 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9036 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9037 // integer datatype.
9038 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9039 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
9040 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
9041 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9042 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009043 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009044 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9045 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9046 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9047 else
9048 break;
9049 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9050 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9051 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9052 else
9053 break;
9054 } else
9055 break;
9056 }
9057
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009058 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009059 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
9060 }
9061 }
9062
9063
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009064 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9065 // infer, use it.
9066 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9067 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9068
9069 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9070 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009071 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9072 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9073 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9074
9075 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9076 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
9077 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009078}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009079
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009080Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9081 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
9082 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
9083 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
9084 return MI;
9085 }
9086
9087 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9088 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9089 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9090 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9091 return 0;
9092 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
9093 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9094
9095 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9096 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9097
9098 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9099 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
9100 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
9101
9102 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
9103 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
9104
9105 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9106 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9107
9108 // Extract the fill value and store.
9109 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
9110 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
9111 Alignment), *MI);
9112
9113 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9114 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9115 return MI;
9116 }
9117
9118 return 0;
9119}
9120
9121
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009122/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9123/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9124/// the heavy lifting.
9125///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009126Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009127 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9128 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9129
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009130 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9131 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009132 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009133 bool Changed = false;
9134
9135 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9136 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9137 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9138
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009139 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009140 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009141 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9142 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9143 // alignment is sufficient.
9144 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009145 }
9146
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009147 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9148 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9149 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009150 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009151 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9152 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9153 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009154 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
9155 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
9156 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00009157 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009158 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
9159 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009160 Changed = true;
9161 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009162
9163 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9164 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9165 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009166 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009167
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009168 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9169 // set, update the alignment.
9170 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009171 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9172 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009173 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9174 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9175 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009176 }
9177
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009178 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009179 }
9180
9181 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9182 default: break;
9183 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9184 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9185 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9186 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9187 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9188 break;
9189 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9190 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9191 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9192 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9193 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9194 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9195 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9196 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9197 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9198 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9199 CI);
9200 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009201 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009202 break;
9203 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9204 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9205 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9206 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9207 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9208 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9209 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9210 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9211 }
9212 break;
9213 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9214 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9215 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009216 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9217 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9218 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9219 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9220 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9221 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9222 }
9223 break;
9224
9225 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9226 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9227 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9228 uint64_t UndefElts;
9229 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9230 UndefElts)) {
9231 II->setOperand(1, V);
9232 return II;
9233 }
9234 break;
9235 }
9236
9237 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9238 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9239 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9240 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009241
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009242 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9243 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9244 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9245 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9246 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9247 AllEltsOk = false;
9248 break;
9249 }
9250 }
9251
9252 if (AllEltsOk) {
9253 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9254 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9255 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9256 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009257
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009258 // Only extract each element once.
9259 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9260 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9261
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009262 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009263 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9264 continue;
9265 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9266 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9267
9268 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9269 Instruction *Elt =
9270 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9271 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9272 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009273 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009274
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009275 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9276 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9277 i, "tmp");
9278 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009279 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009280 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009281 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009282 }
9283 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009284
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009285 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9286 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9287 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9288 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9289 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9290 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9291 if (&*++BI == II)
9292 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009293 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009294 }
9295
9296 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9297 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9298 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9299 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9300 bool CannotRemove = false;
9301 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9302 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9303 CannotRemove = true;
9304 break;
9305 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009306 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9307 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9308 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9309 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9310 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9311 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9312 } else {
9313 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9314 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009315 CannotRemove = true;
9316 break;
9317 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009318 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009319 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009320
9321 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9322 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9323 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9324 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9325 break;
9326 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009327 }
9328
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009329 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009330}
9331
9332// InvokeInst simplification
9333//
9334Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009335 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009336}
9337
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009338/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9339/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009340static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9341 const CastInst * const CI,
9342 const TargetData * const TD,
9343 const int ix) {
9344 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9345 return false;
9346
9347 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9348 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9349 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009350 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009351 return true;
9352
9353 const Type* SrcTy =
9354 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9355 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9356 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9357 return false;
9358 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9359 return false;
9360 return true;
9361}
9362
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009363// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9364//
9365Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009366 bool Changed = false;
9367
9368 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9369 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009370 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9371
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009372 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009373
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009374 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9375 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9376 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9377 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9378 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009379 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009380 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9381 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009382 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9383 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9384 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9385 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9386 return 0;
9387 }
9388
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009389 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9390 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9391 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9392 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009393 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009394 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009395 CS.getInstruction());
9396
9397 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9398 CS.getInstruction()->
9399 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9400
9401 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9402 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009403 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9404 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009405 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009406 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9407 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009408
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009409 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9410 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9411 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9412 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9413
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009414 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9415 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9416 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009417 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009418 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9419 // the call.
9420 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009421 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9422 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9423 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9424 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9425 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009426 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009427 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009428 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009429
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009430 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009431 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009432 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009433 Changed = true;
9434 }
9435
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009436 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009437}
9438
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009439// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9440// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9441//
9442bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9443 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9444 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009445 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9446 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009447 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009448 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009449 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009450 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009451
9452 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9453 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9454 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9455 //
9456 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9457 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009458 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009459
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009460 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009461 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9462
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009463 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009464 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009465 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009466 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9467 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9468 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009469 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009470 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009471
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009472 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009473 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009474 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009475 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9476
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009477 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009478 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009479 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009480 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9481 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009482
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009483 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9484 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9485 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9486 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9487 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9488 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9489 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9490 UI != E; ++UI)
9491 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9492 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009493 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009494 return false;
9495 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009496
9497 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9498 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009499
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009500 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9501 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9502 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009503 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009504
9505 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009506 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9507
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009508 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9509 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009510 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009511
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009512 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9513 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009514 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009515 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9516 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009517 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009518 }
9519
9520 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009521 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009522 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009523
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009524 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9525 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009526 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009527 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9528 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009529 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9530 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009531 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009532 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009533 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009534 return false;
9535 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009536
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009537 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9538 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9539 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9540 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009541 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009542 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9543
9544 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009545 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009546
9547 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9548 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009549 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009550
9551 // Add the new return attributes.
9552 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009553 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009554
9555 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9556 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9557 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9558 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9559 Args.push_back(*AI);
9560 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009561 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009562 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009563 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009564 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009565 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009566
9567 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009568 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009569 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009570 }
9571
9572 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9573 // now...
9574 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9575 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9576
9577 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009578 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009579 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009580 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9581 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009582 } else {
9583 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9584 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9585 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9586 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9587 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009588 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9589 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009590 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009591 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9592 Args.push_back(Cast);
9593 } else {
9594 Args.push_back(*AI);
9595 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009596
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009597 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009598 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009599 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009600 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009601 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009602 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009603
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009604 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9605 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9606
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009607 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009608 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009609
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009610 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009611
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009612 Instruction *NC;
9613 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009614 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009615 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9616 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009617 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009618 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009619 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009620 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9621 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009622 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9623 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009624 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009625 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009626 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009627 }
9628
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009629 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009630 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009631 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009632 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009633 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009634 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009635 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009636
9637 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9638 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9639 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009640 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009641 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9642 } else {
9643 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9644 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9645 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009646 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009647 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009648 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009649 }
9650 }
9651
9652 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9653 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009654 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009655 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009656 return true;
9657}
9658
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009659// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9660// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9661//
9662Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9663 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9664 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9665 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009666 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009667
9668 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9669 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009670 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009671 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009672
9673 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9674 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9675
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009676 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009677 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9678 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9679
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009680 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009681 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009682 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9683 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009684 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009685
9686 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9687 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9688 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009689 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009690 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9691 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009692 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009693 break;
9694 }
9695
9696 if (NestTy) {
9697 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9698 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9699 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9700
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009701 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009702 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009703
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009704 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009705 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9706
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009707 // Add any result attributes.
9708 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009709 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009710
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009711 {
9712 unsigned Idx = 1;
9713 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9714 do {
9715 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009716 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009717 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9718 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9719 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9720 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009721 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009722 }
9723
9724 if (I == E)
9725 break;
9726
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009727 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009728 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009729 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009730 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009731 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009732
9733 ++Idx, ++I;
9734 } while (1);
9735 }
9736
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009737 // Add any function attributes.
9738 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9739 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9740
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009741 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9742 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009743 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009744
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009745 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009746 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9747
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009748 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009749 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009750 {
9751 unsigned Idx = 1;
9752 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9753 E = FTy->param_end();
9754
9755 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009756 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9757 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009758 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009759
9760 if (I == E)
9761 break;
9762
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009763 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009764 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009765
9766 ++Idx, ++I;
9767 } while (1);
9768 }
9769
9770 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9771 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9772 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009773 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009774 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9775 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009776 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009777
9778 Instruction *NewCaller;
9779 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009780 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9781 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9782 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9783 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009784 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009785 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009786 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009787 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9788 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009789 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9790 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9791 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9792 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009793 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009794 }
9795 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9796 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9797 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9798 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9799 return 0;
9800 }
9801 }
9802
9803 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9804 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9805 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9806 Constant *NewCallee =
9807 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9808 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9809 return CS.getInstruction();
9810}
9811
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009812/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9813/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9814/// and a single binop.
9815Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9816 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009817 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9818 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009819 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009820 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9821 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9822
9823 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9824 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009825
9826 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9827 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009828 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009829 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009830 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009831 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009832 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9833 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9834 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009835 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009836
9837 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9838 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9839 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9840 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9841 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009842
9843 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9844 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9845 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009846 }
9847
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009848 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9849
9850 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9851 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9852 // hide them behind a phi.
9853 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9854 return 0;
9855
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009856 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009857 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009858 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009859 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009860 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9861 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009862 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9863 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009864 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9865 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9866 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009867
9868 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009869 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9870 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009871 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9872 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009873 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9874 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9875 }
9876
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009877 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9878 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9879 if (NewLHS) {
9880 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9881 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9882 }
9883 if (NewRHS) {
9884 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9885 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9886 }
9887 }
9888
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009889 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009890 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009891 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009892 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009893 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009894 else {
9895 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009896 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009897 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009898}
9899
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009900/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9901/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9902/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9903/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009904///
9905/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9906/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9907/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009908static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9909 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9910
9911 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9912 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9913 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009914
9915 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9916 // profitable to do this xform.
9917 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9918 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9919 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9920 UI != E; ++UI) {
9921 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9922 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9923 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9924 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9925 }
9926 isAddressTaken = true;
9927 break;
9928 }
9929
9930 if (!isAddressTaken)
9931 return false;
9932 }
9933
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009934 return true;
9935}
9936
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009937
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009938// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9939// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9940// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9941Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9942 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9943
9944 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9945 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9946 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9947 // code size and simplifying code.
9948 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9949 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009950 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009951 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9952 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009953 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009954 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9955 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009956 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009957 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9958 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009959 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9960 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9961 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9962 // load and the PHI.
9963 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9964 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9965 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009966
9967 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9968 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9969 // the path through the other successor.
9970 if (isVolatile &&
9971 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9972 return 0;
9973
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009974 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009975 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009976 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9977 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9978 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009979 } else {
9980 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9981 }
9982
9983 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9984 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9985 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9986 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009987 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009988 return 0;
9989 if (CastSrcTy) {
9990 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9991 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009992 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009993 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9994 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009995 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9996 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9997 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9998 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009999
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010000 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10001 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10002 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010003 if (isVolatile &&
10004 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10005 return 0;
10006
10007
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010008 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10009 return 0;
10010 }
10011 }
10012
10013 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10014 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010015 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10016 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010017 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010018
10019 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10020 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010021
10022 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010023 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10024 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10025 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10026 InVal = 0;
10027 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10028 }
10029
10030 Value *PhiVal;
10031 if (InVal) {
10032 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10033 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10034 PhiVal = InVal;
10035 delete NewPN;
10036 } else {
10037 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10038 PhiVal = NewPN;
10039 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010040
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010041 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010042 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010043 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010044 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010045 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010046 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010047 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010048 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010049 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10050
10051 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10052 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10053 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10054 if (isVolatile)
10055 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10056 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10057
10058 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010059}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010060
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010061/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10062/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010063static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10064 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010065 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10066 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10067
10068 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010069 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010070 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010071
10072 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10073 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10074 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010075
10076 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10077 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010078
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010079 return false;
10080}
10081
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010082/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10083/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10084/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10085static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10086 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10087 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10088 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10089 return true;
10090
10091 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10092 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10093 return false;
10094
10095 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10096 // the value.
10097 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10098 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10099 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10100 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10101 return false;
10102 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10103 return false;
10104 }
10105
10106 return true;
10107}
10108
10109
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010110// PHINode simplification
10111//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010112Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010113 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010114 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010115
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010116 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10117 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10118
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010119 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10120 // reducing code size.
10121 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
10122 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10123 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10124 return Result;
10125
10126 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10127 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10128 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010129 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10130 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10131 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010132 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010133 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10134 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10135 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10136 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010137
10138 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10139 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10140 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10141 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10142 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10143 // late.
10144 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10145 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10146 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10147 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10148 }
10149 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010150
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010151 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10152 // same value, for example:
10153 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10154 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10155 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10156 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10157 {
10158 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10159 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10160 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10161 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10162 ++InValNo;
10163
10164 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10165 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10166
10167 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10168 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10169 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10170 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10171 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10172 break;
10173 }
10174
10175 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10176 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10177 // the value.
10178 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10179 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10180 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10182 }
10183 }
10184 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010185 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010186}
10187
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010188static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10189 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10190 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +000010191 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10192 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010193 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10194 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10195 // used for address computation.
10196 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10197 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10198 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10199 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010200}
10201
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010202
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010203Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010204 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010205 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010206 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010207 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010209
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010210 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10211 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10212
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010213 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10214 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10215 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10216
10217 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010218 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010219
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010220 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10221 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010222
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010223 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010224 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10225 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010226 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010227 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000010228 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10229 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10230 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10231 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10232 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10233 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10234 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010235 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010236 }
10237 }
10238 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010239 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010240 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10241 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010242 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10243 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010244 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010245 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010246 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010247 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010248 MadeChange = true;
10249 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010250 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10251 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010252 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010253 MadeChange = true;
10254 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010255 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10256 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10257 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10258 MadeChange = true;
10259 } else {
10260 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10261 GEP);
10262 *i = Op;
10263 MadeChange = true;
10264 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010265 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010266 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010267 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010268 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10269
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010270 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
10271 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
10272 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010273 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10274 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10275 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10276 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10277 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10278 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010279 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10280 if (I != BCI) {
10281 I->takeName(BCI);
10282 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10283 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10284 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010285 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010286 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010287 }
10288 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10289 }
10290 }
10291
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010292 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10293 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10294 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10295 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010296 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010297 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010298 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010299
10300 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010301 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10302 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10303 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10304 //
10305 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10306 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10307 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10308
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010309 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010310
10311 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10312 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10313 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10314 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010315 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010316
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010317 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010318 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010319 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10320 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10321 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010322 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010323 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10324 Sum = GO1;
10325 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10326 Sum = SO1;
10327 } else {
10328 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10329 // target's pointer size.
10330 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10331 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010332 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010333 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010334 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010335 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010336 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10337 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010338 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010339 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010340
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010341 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010342 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010343 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010344 } else {
10345 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010346 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10347 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010348 }
10349 }
10350 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010351 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10352 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10353 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010354 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010355 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010356 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010357 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010358
10359 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10360 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10361 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10362 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10363 return &GEP;
10364 } else {
10365 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10366 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10367 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10368 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10369 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010370 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010371 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010372 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010373 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010374 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10375 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010376 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10377 }
10378
10379 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010380 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10381 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010382
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010383 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010384 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10385 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10386
10387 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010388 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010389 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10390 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10391 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10392
10393 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010394 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10395 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010396
10397 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10399 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010400 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010401 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10402 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10403 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010404 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10405 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010406 //
10407 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10408 //
10409 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10410 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10411 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10412 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10413 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10414 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10415 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10416 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10417 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10418 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10419 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10420 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10421 return &GEP;
10422 }
10423 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10424 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010425 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10426 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010427 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10428 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10429 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010430 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10431 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010432 Value *Idx[2];
10433 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10434 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010435 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010436 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010437 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10438 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010439 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010440
10441 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010442 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010443 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010444 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010445
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010446 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010447 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010448 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010449
10450 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10451 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10452 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10453 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10454 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10455 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10456 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10457 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010458 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010459 Scale = CI;
10460 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10461 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10462 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010463 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10464 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10465 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010466 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10467 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10468 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10469 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10470 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10471 }
10472 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010473
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010474 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010475 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10476 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10477 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10478 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10479 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10480 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10481 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010482 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010483 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010484 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010485 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010486 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10487 }
10488
10489 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010490 Value *Idx[2];
10491 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10492 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010493 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010494 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010495 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10496 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10497 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010498 }
10499 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010500 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010501 }
10502
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010503 return 0;
10504}
10505
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010506Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10507 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010508 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010509 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10510 const Type *NewTy =
10511 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010512 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010513
10514 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10515 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010516 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010517 else {
10518 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010519 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010520 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010521
10522 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010523
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010524 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10525 // allocas if possible...
10526 //
10527 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10528 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10529
10530 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10531 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10532 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010533 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010534 Value *Idx[2];
10535 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10536 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010537 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10538 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010539
10540 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10541 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010542 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010543 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010545 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010546 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010547
10548 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10549 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10550 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010551 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010552 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010553 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10554
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010555 return 0;
10556}
10557
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010558Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10559 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10560
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010561 // free undef -> unreachable.
10562 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10563 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010564 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010565 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010566 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10567 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010568
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010569 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10570 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010571 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010572 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010573
10574 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10575 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10576 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10577 return &FI;
10578 }
10579
10580 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10581 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10582 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10583 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10584 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10585 return &FI;
10586 }
10587 }
10588
10589 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10590 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10591 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10592 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10593 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10594 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010595
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010596 return 0;
10597}
10598
10599
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010600/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010601static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010602 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010603 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010604 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010605
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010606 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10607 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10608 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010609 std::string Str;
10610 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010611 unsigned len = Str.length();
10612 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10613 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10614 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10615 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010616 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10617 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10618 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10619 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10620 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10621 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10622 }
10623 } else {
10624 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10625 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10626 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10627 }
10628 // Append NULL at the end.
10629 SingleChar = 0;
10630 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10631 }
10632 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10633 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010634 }
10635 }
10636 }
10637
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010638 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010639 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010640 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010641
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010642 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010643 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010644 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10645 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10646 // constants.
10647 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10648 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10649 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010650 Value *Idxs[2];
10651 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10652 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010653 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10654 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10655 }
10656
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010657 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010658 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010659 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10660 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10661 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010662 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10663 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010664
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010665 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10666 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10667 // the result of the loaded value.
10668 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10669 CI->getName(),
10670 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10671 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010672 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010673 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010674 }
10675 }
10676 return 0;
10677}
10678
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010679/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010680/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10681/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10682/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10683static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010684 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10685 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10686
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010687 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010688 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010689 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010690 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010691
10692 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10693 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010694 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10695 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10696 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010697 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10698
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010699 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010700 --BBI;
10701
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010702 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10703 // marked invalid.
10704 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10705 return false;
10706
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010707 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10708 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010709 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010710 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010711 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010712
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010713 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010714 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010715}
10716
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010717/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
10718/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
10719/// value in code like this:
10720/// %t0 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10721/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
10722/// %t1 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10723/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
10724///
10725static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
10726 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
10727 if (A == B) return true;
10728
10729 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
10730 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
10731 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
10732 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
10733 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
10734 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
10735 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
10736 return true;
10737
10738 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
10739 return false;
10740}
10741
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010742Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10743 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010744
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010745 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010746 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10747 if (KnownAlign >
10748 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10749 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010750 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10751
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010752 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010753 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010754 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010755 return Res;
10756
10757 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10758 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010759
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010760 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
10761 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
10762 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
10763 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
10764 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != LI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10765 --ScanInsts) {
10766 --BBI;
10767
10768 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10769 if (equivalentAddressValues(SI->getOperand(1), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010770 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010771 } else if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10772 if (equivalentAddressValues(LIB->getOperand(0), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010773 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010774 }
10775
10776 // Don't skip over things that can modify memory.
10777 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10778 break;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010779 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010780
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010781 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10782 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10783 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10784 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10785 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010786 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10787 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10788 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10789 // CFG.
10790 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10791 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10793 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010794 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010795
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010796 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010797 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010798 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10799 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10800 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010801 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10802 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10803 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010804 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10805 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010807 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010808
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010809 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10810 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010811 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010813
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010814 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010815 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010816 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10817 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010818 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010819 if (Constant *V =
10820 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010822 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10823 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10824 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10825 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10826 // CFG.
10827 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10828 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10829 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10830 }
10831
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010832 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010833 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010834 return Res;
10835 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010836 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010837 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010838
10839 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10840 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010841 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010842 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10843 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10845 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10847 }
10848 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010849
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010850 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010851 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10852 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10853 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10854 //
10855 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10856 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10857 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10858 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10859 // unconditionally.
10860 //
10861 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10862 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010863 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10864 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010865 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010866 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010867 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010868 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010869 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010870 }
10871
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010872 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10873 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10874 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10875 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10876 return &LI;
10877 }
10878
10879 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10880 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10881 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10882 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10883 return &LI;
10884 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010885 }
10886 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010887 return 0;
10888}
10889
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010890/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010891/// when possible.
10892static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10893 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10894 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10895
10896 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10897 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10898 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10899
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010900 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010901 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10902 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10903 // constants.
10904 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10905 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10906 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010907 Value* Idxs[2];
10908 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10909 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010910 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10911 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10912 }
10913
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010914 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10915 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10916 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010917
10918 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010919 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10920 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010921 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010922 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010923 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10924 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10925 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10926 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10927 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010928 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010929 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010930 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010931 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10932 }
10933 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010934 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010935 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010936 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010937 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010938 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010939 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10940 }
10941 }
10942 }
10943 return 0;
10944}
10945
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010946Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10947 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10948 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10949
10950 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010951 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010952 ++NumCombined;
10953 return 0;
10954 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010955
10956 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10957 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010958 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010959 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10960 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10961 ++NumCombined;
10962 return 0;
10963 }
10964
10965 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10966 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10967 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10968 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10969 ++NumCombined;
10970 return 0;
10971 }
10972 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010973
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010974 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010975 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10976 if (KnownAlign >
10977 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10978 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010979 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10980
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010981 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10982 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10983 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10984 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10985 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10986 --ScanInsts) {
10987 --BBI;
10988
10989 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10990 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010991 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
10992 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010993 ++NumDeadStore;
10994 ++BBI;
10995 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10996 continue;
10997 }
10998 break;
10999 }
11000
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011001 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11002 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11003 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11004 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011005 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11006 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011007 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11008 ++NumCombined;
11009 return 0;
11010 }
11011 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11012 // may not be dead.
11013 break;
11014 }
11015
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011016 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011017 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011018 break;
11019 }
11020
11021
11022 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011023
11024 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
11025 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
11026 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
11027 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
11028 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011029 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011030 ++NumCombined;
11031 }
11032 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11033 }
11034
11035 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11036 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011037 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011038 ++NumCombined;
11039 return 0;
11040 }
11041
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011042 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11043 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011044 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011045 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11046 return Res;
11047 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011048 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011049 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11050 return Res;
11051
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011052
11053 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
11054 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011055 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011056 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011057 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11058 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11059 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011060
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011061 return 0;
11062}
11063
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011064/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11065/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11066/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11067///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011068/// Simplify things like:
11069/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11070/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11071///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011072bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11073 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11074
11075 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11076 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11077 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011078 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011079
11080 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11081 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011082 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11083 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011084 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011085 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011086 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011087 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011088 return false;
11089
11090 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011091 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011092 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011093 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011094 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011095 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011096 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011097
11098 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11099 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11100 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11101 return false;
11102
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011103 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11104 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011105 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011106 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011107 return false;
11108
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011109 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11110 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11111 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11112 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
11113 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
11114 --BBI;
11115 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11116 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11117 return false;
11118 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011119 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011120 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11121 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11122 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11123 return false;
11124
11125 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011126 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11127 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011128 for (;; --BBI) {
11129 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11130 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11131 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11132 return false;
11133 break;
11134 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011135 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11136 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11137 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011138 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11139 return false;
11140 }
11141
11142 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011143 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11144 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011145 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11146 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011147 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011148 return false;
11149 }
11150 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011151
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011152 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011153 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11154 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011155 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011156 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11157 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011158 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11159 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011160 }
11161
11162 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11163 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011164 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011165 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11166 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11167
11168 // Nuke the old stores.
11169 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11170 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11171 ++NumCombined;
11172 return true;
11173}
11174
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011175
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011176Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11177 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011178 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011179 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11180 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11181 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11182 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11183 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11184 BI.setCondition(X);
11185 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11186 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11187 return &BI;
11188 }
11189
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011190 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11191 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11192 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11193 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11194 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11195 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11196 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011197 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011198 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11199 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011200 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11201 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11202 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11203 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011204 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011205 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011206 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011207 return &BI;
11208 }
11209
11210 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11211 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11212 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11213 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11214 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11215 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11216 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11217 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011218 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011219 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11220 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011221 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011222 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011223 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11224 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011225 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011226 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011227 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011228 return &BI;
11229 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011230
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011231 return 0;
11232}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011233
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011234Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11235 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11236 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11237 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11238 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11239 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11240 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011241 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011242 AddRHS));
11243 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011244 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011245 return &SI;
11246 }
11247 }
11248 return 0;
11249}
11250
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011251Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011252 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011253
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011254 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11255 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11256
11257 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11258 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11260
11261 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11262 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11263
11264 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11265 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11266 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11267 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11268 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11269 // first index
11270 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11271 else
11272 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11273 }
11274 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11275 }
11276 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11277 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11278 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11279 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11280 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11281 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11282 ++exti, ++insi) {
11283 if (*insi != *exti)
11284 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11285 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11286 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11287 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11288 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11289 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11290 // with
11291 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11292 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11293 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11294 }
11295 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11296 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11297 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11298 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11299 // with "i32 42"
11300 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11301 if (exti == exte) {
11302 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11303 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11304 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11305 // with
11306 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11307 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11308 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11309 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11310 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11311 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11312 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11313 EV);
11314 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11315 insi, inse);
11316 }
11317 if (insi == inse)
11318 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11319 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11320 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11321 // i.e., replace
11322 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11323 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11324 // with
11325 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11326 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11327 exti, exte);
11328 }
11329 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11330 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11331 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11332 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011333 return 0;
11334}
11335
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011336/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11337/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11338static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11339 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11340 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011341 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011342 if (isConstant) return true;
11343 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11344 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11345 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11346 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11347 return false;
11348 return true;
11349 }
11350 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11351 if (!I) return false;
11352
11353 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11354 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11355 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11356 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11357 return true;
11358 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11359 return true;
11360 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11361 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11362 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11363 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11364 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011365 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11366 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11367 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11368 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11369 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011370
11371 return false;
11372}
11373
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011374/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11375///
11376/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11377/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011378static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11379 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11380 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11381 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11382 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11383 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11384
11385 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011386 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011387 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11388 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011389 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11390 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011391 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011392 return Result;
11393}
11394
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011395/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11396/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11397/// extracted from the vector.
11398static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011399 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11400 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011401 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11402 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011403 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11404
11405 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11406 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11407 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11408 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011409 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011410 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11411 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11412 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011413 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11414 return 0;
11415 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011416
11417 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11418 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011419 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11420 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011421
11422 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11423 // vector input.
11424 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011425 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011426 unsigned LHSWidth =
11427 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011428 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011429 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011430 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011431 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
11432 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011433 else
11434 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011435 }
11436
11437 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11438 return 0;
11439}
11440
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011441Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011442 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011443 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11444 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11445
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011446 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011447 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11448 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11449
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011450 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011451 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11452 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11453 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011454 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011455 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011456 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11457 op0 = 0;
11458 break;
11459 }
11460 if (op0)
11461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011462 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011463
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011464 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11465 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011466 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011467 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11468 unsigned VectorWidth =
11469 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11470
11471 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11472 // crashing the code below.
11473 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11474 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11475
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011476 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11477 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11478 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011479 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011480 uint64_t UndefElts;
11481 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011482 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011483 UndefElts)) {
11484 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11485 return &EI;
11486 }
11487 }
11488
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011489 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011490 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011491
11492 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11493 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11494 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11495 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11496 if (const VectorType *VT =
11497 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11498 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11499 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11500 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11501 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011502 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011503
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011504 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011505 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11506 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11507 // profitable to do so
11508 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011509 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11510 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11511 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11512 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11513 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11514 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11515 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11516 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11517 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11518 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011519 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011520 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011521 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011522 unsigned AS =
11523 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011524 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11525 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011526 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11527 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011528 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11529 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011530 }
11531 }
11532 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11533 // Extracting the inserted element?
11534 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11535 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11536 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11537 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11538 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11539 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11540 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11541 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11542 return &EI;
11543 }
11544 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11545 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11546 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011547 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11548 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011549 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011550 unsigned LHSWidth =
11551 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11552
11553 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011554 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011555 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
11556 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011557 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11558 } else {
11559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011560 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011561 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011562 }
11563 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011564 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011565 return 0;
11566}
11567
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011568/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11569/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11570/// Otherwise, return false.
11571static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11572 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11573 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11574 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011575 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011576
11577 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011578 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011579 return true;
11580 } else if (V == LHS) {
11581 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011582 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011583 return true;
11584 } else if (V == RHS) {
11585 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011586 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011587 return true;
11588 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11589 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11590 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11591 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11592 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11593
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011594 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11595 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011596 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011597
11598 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11599 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11600 // transitively ok.
11601 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11602 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011603 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011604 return true;
11605 }
11606 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11607 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011608 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11609 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011610 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011611
11612 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11613 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11614 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11615 // transitively ok.
11616 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11617 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11618 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011619 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011620 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011621 } else {
11622 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011623 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011624 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011625
11626 }
11627 return true;
11628 }
11629 }
11630 }
11631 }
11632 }
11633 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11634
11635 return false;
11636}
11637
11638/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11639/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11640/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011641static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011642 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011643 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011644 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011645 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011646 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011647
11648 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011649 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011650 return V;
11651 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011652 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011653 return V;
11654 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11655 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11656 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11657 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11658 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11659
11660 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11661 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11662 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11663 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011664 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11665 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011666
11667 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11668 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011669 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11670 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11671 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011672 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011673 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011674 return V;
11675 }
11676
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011677 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11678 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011679 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11680 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11681 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011682 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011683 }
11684 return V;
11685 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011686
11687 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11688 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11689 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11690 return EI->getOperand(0);
11691
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011692 }
11693 }
11694 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011695 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011696
11697 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11698 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011699 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011700 return V;
11701}
11702
11703Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11704 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11705 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11706 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11707
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011708 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11709 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11710 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11711
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011712 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11713 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11714 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11715 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11716 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11717 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011718 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11719 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011720 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011721
11722 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11724
11725 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11726 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11727
11728 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11729 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11730 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11731 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11732
11733 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11734 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11735 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11736 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11737 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11738 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11739 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11740 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11741 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11742 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011743 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011744 else {
11745 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011746 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011747 NumVectorElts));
11748 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011749 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011750 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011751 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011752 }
11753
11754 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11755 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11756 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11757 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011758 Value *RHS = 0;
11759 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11760 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11761 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011762 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011763 }
11764 }
11765 }
11766
11767 return 0;
11768}
11769
11770
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011771Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11772 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11773 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011774 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011775
11776 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011777
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011778 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011779 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011780 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011781
11782 uint64_t UndefElts;
11783 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011784
11785 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
11786 return 0;
11787
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011788 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11789 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011790 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11791 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11792 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011793 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011794 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011795
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011796 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11797 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11798 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11799 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011800 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11801 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11802 }
11803
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011804 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11805 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11806 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011807 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011808 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011809 else {
11810 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011811 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011812 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011813 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11814 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011815 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011816 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11817 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011818 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011819 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011820 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011821 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011822 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011823 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11824 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011825 MadeChange = true;
11826 }
11827
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011828 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011829 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011830
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011831 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11832 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11833 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11834 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11835
11836 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11837 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011838 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011839
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011840 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11841 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11842 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011843
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011844 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11845 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11846 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11847 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11848 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11849 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11850 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11851 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11852 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11853 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11854 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11855 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11856
11857 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11858 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11859 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11860 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11861 else
11862 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11863
11864 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11865 // the replacement.
11866 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11867 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11868 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11869 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011870 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011871 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011872 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011873 }
11874 }
11875 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11876 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011877 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011878 }
11879 }
11880 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011881
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011882 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11883}
11884
11885
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011886
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011887
11888/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11889/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11890/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11891/// end of its block.
11892static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11893 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11894
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011895 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011896 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11897 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011898
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011899 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011900 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11901 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011902 return false;
11903
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011904 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11905 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011906 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11907 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011908 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11909 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11910 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011911 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011912
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011913 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011914
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011915 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011916 ++NumSunkInst;
11917 return true;
11918}
11919
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011920
11921/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11922/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11923///
11924/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11925/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11926/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11927/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11928/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11929///
11930static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011931 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011932 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011933 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011934 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011935 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011936
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011937 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11938 BB = Worklist.back();
11939 Worklist.pop_back();
11940
11941 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11942 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11943
11944 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11945 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011946
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011947 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11948 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11949 ++NumDeadInst;
11950 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11951 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11952 continue;
11953 }
11954
11955 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11956 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11957 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11958 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11959 ++NumConstProp;
11960 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11961 continue;
11962 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011963
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011964 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011965 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011966
11967 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11968 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11969 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11970 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11971 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11972 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011973 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011974 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011975 continue;
11976 }
11977 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11978 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11979 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11980 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11981 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011982 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011983 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011984 continue;
11985 }
11986
11987 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11988 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11989 continue;
11990 }
11991 }
11992
11993 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11994 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011995 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011996}
11997
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011998bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011999 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000012000 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012001
12002 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12003 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012004
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012005 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012006 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12007 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12008 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012009 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012010 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012011
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012012 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12013 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12014 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12015 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12016 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12017 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12018 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12019 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012020
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012021 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012022 ++NumDeadInst;
12023
12024 if (!I->use_empty())
12025 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
12026 I->eraseFromParent();
12027 }
12028 }
12029 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012030
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012031 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12032 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12033 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012034
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012035 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012036 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012037 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012038 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012039 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012040 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012041
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012042 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012043
12044 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012045 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012046 continue;
12047 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012048
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012049 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000012050 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012051 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012052
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012053 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012054 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012055 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12056
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012057 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012058 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012059 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012060 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012061 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012062
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012063 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
12064 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
12065 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
12066 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
12067 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
12068 i->set(NewC);
12069 }
12070 }
12071 }
12072
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012073 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012074 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012075 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12076 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12077 if (UserParent != BB) {
12078 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12079 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12080 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12081 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12082 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12083 break;
12084 }
12085
12086 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12087 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12088 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12089 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12090 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12091 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
12092 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
12093 }
12094 }
12095
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012096 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012097#ifndef NDEBUG
12098 std::string OrigI;
12099#endif
12100 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012101 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012102 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012103 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012104 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012105 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
12106 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012107
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012108 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12109 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12110
12111 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012112 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012113 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012114
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012115 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12116 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012117
12118 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12119 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012120 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12121
12122 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12123 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12124 ++InsertPos;
12125
12126 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012127
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012128 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
12129 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012130 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000012131
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012132 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
12133 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012134 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012135
12136 // Erase the old instruction.
12137 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012138 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012139#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012140 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
12141 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012142#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012143
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012144 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12145 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012146 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12147 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
12148 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012149 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012150
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012151 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012152 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012153 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012154 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012155 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012156 AddToWorkList(I);
12157 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012158 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012159 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012160 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012161 }
12162 }
12163
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012164 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012165
12166 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12167 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012168 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012169}
12170
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012171
12172bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012173 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12174
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012175 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12176
12177 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12178 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012179 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012180 EverMadeChange = true;
12181 return EverMadeChange;
12182}
12183
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012184FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012185 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012186}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000012187
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012188